Transaction Hash:
Block:
17373976 at May-30-2023 08:00:11 PM +UTC
Transaction Fee:
0.005431823653697517 ETH
$13.74
Gas Used:
123,083 Gas / 44.131388199 Gwei
Emitted Events:
537 |
UnchainedMilady.Transfer( from=0x00000000...000000000, to=[Sender] 0x349a163d796546d34e8998948a205fdaee14e718, tokenId=35 )
|
Account State Difference:
Address | Before | After | State Difference | ||
---|---|---|---|---|---|
0x1f9090aa...8e676c326
Miner
| 8.806182991010239392 Eth | 8.806206692720638179 Eth | 0.000023701710398787 | ||
0x25f23845...DF5398A4d | |||||
0x349a163d...AeE14e718 |
0.051960492037706954 Eth
Nonce: 23
|
0.046528668384009437 Eth
Nonce: 24
| 0.005431823653697517 |
Execution Trace
UnchainedMilady.CALL( )

-
Miladys.balanceOf( owner=0x349a163d796546d34e8998948a205FdAeE14e718 ) => ( 0 )
-
SSRWives.balanceOf( owner=0x349a163d796546d34e8998948a205FdAeE14e718 ) => ( 0 )
Archetype.balanceOf( owner=0x349a163d796546d34e8998948a205FdAeE14e718 ) => ( 2 )
-
Archetype.balanceOf( owner=0x349a163d796546d34e8998948a205FdAeE14e718 ) => ( 2 )
-
File 1 of 5: UnchainedMilady
File 2 of 5: Miladys
File 3 of 5: SSRWives
File 4 of 5: Archetype
File 5 of 5: Archetype
// Sources flattened with hardhat v2.12.6 https://hardhat.org // File @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/[email protected] // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Context.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.0; /** * @dev Provides information about the current execution context, including the * sender of the transaction and its data. While these are generally available * via msg.sender and msg.data, they should not be accessed in such a direct * manner, since when dealing with meta-transactions the account sending and * paying for execution may not be the actual sender (as far as an application * is concerned). * * This contract is only required for intermediate, library-like contracts. */ abstract contract Context { function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address) { return msg.sender; } function _msgData() internal view virtual returns (bytes calldata) { return msg.data; } } // File @openzeppelin/contracts/access/[email protected] // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (access/Ownable.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.0; /** * @dev Contract module which provides a basic access control mechanism, where * there is an account (an owner) that can be granted exclusive access to * specific functions. * * By default, the owner account will be the one that deploys the contract. This * can later be changed with {transferOwnership}. * * This module is used through inheritance. It will make available the modifier * `onlyOwner`, which can be applied to your functions to restrict their use to * the owner. */ abstract contract Ownable is Context { address private _owner; event OwnershipTransferred(address indexed previousOwner, address indexed newOwner); /** * @dev Initializes the contract setting the deployer as the initial owner. */ constructor() { _transferOwnership(_msgSender()); } /** * @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner. */ modifier onlyOwner() { _checkOwner(); _; } /** * @dev Returns the address of the current owner. */ function owner() public view virtual returns (address) { return _owner; } /** * @dev Throws if the sender is not the owner. */ function _checkOwner() internal view virtual { require(owner() == _msgSender(), "Ownable: caller is not the owner"); } /** * @dev Leaves the contract without owner. It will not be possible to call * `onlyOwner` functions anymore. Can only be called by the current owner. * * NOTE: Renouncing ownership will leave the contract without an owner, * thereby removing any functionality that is only available to the owner. */ function renounceOwnership() public virtual onlyOwner { _transferOwnership(address(0)); } /** * @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`). * Can only be called by the current owner. */ function transferOwnership(address newOwner) public virtual onlyOwner { require(newOwner != address(0), "Ownable: new owner is the zero address"); _transferOwnership(newOwner); } /** * @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`). * Internal function without access restriction. */ function _transferOwnership(address newOwner) internal virtual { address oldOwner = _owner; _owner = newOwner; emit OwnershipTransferred(oldOwner, newOwner); } } // File @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/introspection/[email protected] // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/IERC165.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.0; /** * @dev Interface of the ERC165 standard, as defined in the * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165[EIP]. * * Implementers can declare support of contract interfaces, which can then be * queried by others ({ERC165Checker}). * * For an implementation, see {ERC165}. */ interface IERC165 { /** * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified[EIP section] * to learn more about how these ids are created. * * This function call must use less than 30 000 gas. */ function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool); } // File @openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/[email protected] // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (token/ERC721/IERC721.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.0; /** * @dev Required interface of an ERC721 compliant contract. */ interface IERC721 is IERC165 { /** * @dev Emitted when `tokenId` token is transferred from `from` to `to`. */ event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 indexed tokenId); /** * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables `approved` to manage the `tokenId` token. */ event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed approved, uint256 indexed tokenId); /** * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables or disables (`approved`) `operator` to manage all of its assets. */ event ApprovalForAll(address indexed owner, address indexed operator, bool approved); /** * @dev Returns the number of tokens in ``owner``'s account. */ function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256 balance); /** * @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. */ function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address owner); /** * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`. * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function safeTransferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes calldata data ) external; /** * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`, checking first that contract recipients * are aware of the ERC721 protocol to prevent tokens from being forever locked. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`. * - If the caller is not `from`, it must have been allowed to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function safeTransferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) external; /** * @dev Transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`. * * WARNING: Note that the caller is responsible to confirm that the recipient is capable of receiving ERC721 * or else they may be permanently lost. Usage of {safeTransferFrom} prevents loss, though the caller must * understand this adds an external call which potentially creates a reentrancy vulnerability. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`. * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) external; /** * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account. * The approval is cleared when the token is transferred. * * Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the zero address clears previous approvals. * * Requirements: * * - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator. * - `tokenId` must exist. * * Emits an {Approval} event. */ function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) external; /** * @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller. * Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom} for any token owned by the caller. * * Requirements: * * - The `operator` cannot be the caller. * * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event. */ function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool _approved) external; /** * @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. */ function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address operator); /** * @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`. * * See {setApprovalForAll} */ function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) external view returns (bool); } // File erc721a/contracts/[email protected] // ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3 // Creator: Chiru Labs pragma solidity ^0.8.4; /** * @dev Interface of ERC721A. */ interface IERC721A { /** * The caller must own the token or be an approved operator. */ error ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved(); /** * The token does not exist. */ error ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken(); /** * Cannot query the balance for the zero address. */ error BalanceQueryForZeroAddress(); /** * Cannot mint to the zero address. */ error MintToZeroAddress(); /** * The quantity of tokens minted must be more than zero. */ error MintZeroQuantity(); /** * The token does not exist. */ error OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken(); /** * The caller must own the token or be an approved operator. */ error TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved(); /** * The token must be owned by `from`. */ error TransferFromIncorrectOwner(); /** * Cannot safely transfer to a contract that does not implement the * ERC721Receiver interface. */ error TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer(); /** * Cannot transfer to the zero address. */ error TransferToZeroAddress(); /** * The token does not exist. */ error URIQueryForNonexistentToken(); /** * The `quantity` minted with ERC2309 exceeds the safety limit. */ error MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit(); /** * The `extraData` cannot be set on an unintialized ownership slot. */ error OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData(); // ============================================================= // STRUCTS // ============================================================= struct TokenOwnership { // The address of the owner. address addr; // Stores the start time of ownership with minimal overhead for tokenomics. uint64 startTimestamp; // Whether the token has been burned. bool burned; // Arbitrary data similar to `startTimestamp` that can be set via {_extraData}. uint24 extraData; } // ============================================================= // TOKEN COUNTERS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence. * Burned tokens will reduce the count. * To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}. */ function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256); // ============================================================= // IERC165 // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding * [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified) * to learn more about how these ids are created. * * This function call must use less than 30000 gas. */ function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool); // ============================================================= // IERC721 // ============================================================= /** * @dev Emitted when `tokenId` token is transferred from `from` to `to`. */ event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 indexed tokenId); /** * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables `approved` to manage the `tokenId` token. */ event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed approved, uint256 indexed tokenId); /** * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables or disables * (`approved`) `operator` to manage all of its assets. */ event ApprovalForAll(address indexed owner, address indexed operator, bool approved); /** * @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account. */ function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256 balance); /** * @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. */ function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address owner); /** * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`, * checking first that contract recipients are aware of the ERC721 protocol * to prevent tokens from being forever locked. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`. * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be have been allowed to move * this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement * {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function safeTransferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes calldata data ) external payable; /** * @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`. */ function safeTransferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) external payable; /** * @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`. * * WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {safeTransferFrom} * whenever possible. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`. * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token * by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) external payable; /** * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account. * The approval is cleared when the token is transferred. * * Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the * zero address clears previous approvals. * * Requirements: * * - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator. * - `tokenId` must exist. * * Emits an {Approval} event. */ function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) external payable; /** * @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller. * Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom} * for any token owned by the caller. * * Requirements: * * - The `operator` cannot be the caller. * * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event. */ function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool _approved) external; /** * @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. */ function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address operator); /** * @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`. * * See {setApprovalForAll}. */ function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) external view returns (bool); // ============================================================= // IERC721Metadata // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the token collection name. */ function name() external view returns (string memory); /** * @dev Returns the token collection symbol. */ function symbol() external view returns (string memory); /** * @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token. */ function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (string memory); // ============================================================= // IERC2309 // ============================================================= /** * @dev Emitted when tokens in `fromTokenId` to `toTokenId` * (inclusive) is transferred from `from` to `to`, as defined in the * [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309) standard. * * See {_mintERC2309} for more details. */ event ConsecutiveTransfer(uint256 indexed fromTokenId, uint256 toTokenId, address indexed from, address indexed to); } // File erc721a/contracts/[email protected] // ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3 // Creator: Chiru Labs pragma solidity ^0.8.4; /** * @dev Interface of ERC721 token receiver. */ interface ERC721A__IERC721Receiver { function onERC721Received( address operator, address from, uint256 tokenId, bytes calldata data ) external returns (bytes4); } /** * @title ERC721A * * @dev Implementation of the [ERC721](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-721) * Non-Fungible Token Standard, including the Metadata extension. * Optimized for lower gas during batch mints. * * Token IDs are minted in sequential order (e.g. 0, 1, 2, 3, ...) * starting from `_startTokenId()`. * * Assumptions: * * - An owner cannot have more than 2**64 - 1 (max value of uint64) of supply. * - The maximum token ID cannot exceed 2**256 - 1 (max value of uint256). */ contract ERC721A is IERC721A { // Bypass for a `--via-ir` bug (https://github.com/chiru-labs/ERC721A/pull/364). struct TokenApprovalRef { address value; } // ============================================================= // CONSTANTS // ============================================================= // Mask of an entry in packed address data. uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY = (1 << 64) - 1; // The bit position of `numberMinted` in packed address data. uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED = 64; // The bit position of `numberBurned` in packed address data. uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED = 128; // The bit position of `aux` in packed address data. uint256 private constant _BITPOS_AUX = 192; // Mask of all 256 bits in packed address data except the 64 bits for `aux`. uint256 private constant _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 192) - 1; // The bit position of `startTimestamp` in packed ownership. uint256 private constant _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP = 160; // The bit mask of the `burned` bit in packed ownership. uint256 private constant _BITMASK_BURNED = 1 << 224; // The bit position of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership. uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 225; // The bit mask of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership. uint256 private constant _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 1 << 225; // The bit position of `extraData` in packed ownership. uint256 private constant _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA = 232; // Mask of all 256 bits in a packed ownership except the 24 bits for `extraData`. uint256 private constant _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 232) - 1; // The mask of the lower 160 bits for addresses. uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS = (1 << 160) - 1; // The maximum `quantity` that can be minted with {_mintERC2309}. // This limit is to prevent overflows on the address data entries. // For a limit of 5000, a total of 3.689e15 calls to {_mintERC2309} // is required to cause an overflow, which is unrealistic. uint256 private constant _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT = 5000; // The `Transfer` event signature is given by: // `keccak256(bytes("Transfer(address,address,uint256)"))`. bytes32 private constant _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE = 0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef; // ============================================================= // STORAGE // ============================================================= // The next token ID to be minted. uint256 private _currentIndex; // The number of tokens burned. uint256 private _burnCounter; // Token name string private _name; // Token symbol string private _symbol; // Mapping from token ID to ownership details // An empty struct value does not necessarily mean the token is unowned. // See {_packedOwnershipOf} implementation for details. // // Bits Layout: // - [0..159] `addr` // - [160..223] `startTimestamp` // - [224] `burned` // - [225] `nextInitialized` // - [232..255] `extraData` mapping(uint256 => uint256) private _packedOwnerships; // Mapping owner address to address data. // // Bits Layout: // - [0..63] `balance` // - [64..127] `numberMinted` // - [128..191] `numberBurned` // - [192..255] `aux` mapping(address => uint256) private _packedAddressData; // Mapping from token ID to approved address. mapping(uint256 => TokenApprovalRef) private _tokenApprovals; // Mapping from owner to operator approvals mapping(address => mapping(address => bool)) private _operatorApprovals; // ============================================================= // CONSTRUCTOR // ============================================================= constructor(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) { _name = name_; _symbol = symbol_; _currentIndex = _startTokenId(); } // ============================================================= // TOKEN COUNTING OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the starting token ID. * To change the starting token ID, please override this function. */ function _startTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) { return 0; } /** * @dev Returns the next token ID to be minted. */ function _nextTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) { return _currentIndex; } /** * @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence. * Burned tokens will reduce the count. * To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}. */ function totalSupply() public view virtual override returns (uint256) { // Counter underflow is impossible as _burnCounter cannot be incremented // more than `_currentIndex - _startTokenId()` times. unchecked { return _currentIndex - _burnCounter - _startTokenId(); } } /** * @dev Returns the total amount of tokens minted in the contract. */ function _totalMinted() internal view virtual returns (uint256) { // Counter underflow is impossible as `_currentIndex` does not decrement, // and it is initialized to `_startTokenId()`. unchecked { return _currentIndex - _startTokenId(); } } /** * @dev Returns the total number of tokens burned. */ function _totalBurned() internal view virtual returns (uint256) { return _burnCounter; } // ============================================================= // ADDRESS DATA OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account. */ function balanceOf(address owner) public view virtual override returns (uint256) { if (owner == address(0)) revert BalanceQueryForZeroAddress(); return _packedAddressData[owner] & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY; } /** * Returns the number of tokens minted by `owner`. */ function _numberMinted(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) { return (_packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY; } /** * Returns the number of tokens burned by or on behalf of `owner`. */ function _numberBurned(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) { return (_packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY; } /** * Returns the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used). */ function _getAux(address owner) internal view returns (uint64) { return uint64(_packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_AUX); } /** * Sets the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used). * If there are multiple variables, please pack them into a uint64. */ function _setAux(address owner, uint64 aux) internal virtual { uint256 packed = _packedAddressData[owner]; uint256 auxCasted; // Cast `aux` with assembly to avoid redundant masking. assembly { auxCasted := aux } packed = (packed & _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT) | (auxCasted << _BITPOS_AUX); _packedAddressData[owner] = packed; } // ============================================================= // IERC165 // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding * [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified) * to learn more about how these ids are created. * * This function call must use less than 30000 gas. */ function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) { // The interface IDs are constants representing the first 4 bytes // of the XOR of all function selectors in the interface. // See: [ERC165](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165) // (e.g. `bytes4(i.functionA.selector ^ i.functionB.selector ^ ...)`) return interfaceId == 0x01ffc9a7 || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC165. interfaceId == 0x80ac58cd || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721. interfaceId == 0x5b5e139f; // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721Metadata. } // ============================================================= // IERC721Metadata // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the token collection name. */ function name() public view virtual override returns (string memory) { return _name; } /** * @dev Returns the token collection symbol. */ function symbol() public view virtual override returns (string memory) { return _symbol; } /** * @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token. */ function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (string memory) { if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert URIQueryForNonexistentToken(); string memory baseURI = _baseURI(); return bytes(baseURI).length != 0 ? string(abi.encodePacked(baseURI, _toString(tokenId))) : ''; } /** * @dev Base URI for computing {tokenURI}. If set, the resulting URI for each * token will be the concatenation of the `baseURI` and the `tokenId`. Empty * by default, it can be overridden in child contracts. */ function _baseURI() internal view virtual returns (string memory) { return ''; } // ============================================================= // OWNERSHIPS OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. */ function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) { return address(uint160(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId))); } /** * @dev Gas spent here starts off proportional to the maximum mint batch size. * It gradually moves to O(1) as tokens get transferred around over time. */ function _ownershipOf(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) { return _unpackedOwnership(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId)); } /** * @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct at `index`. */ function _ownershipAt(uint256 index) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) { return _unpackedOwnership(_packedOwnerships[index]); } /** * @dev Initializes the ownership slot minted at `index` for efficiency purposes. */ function _initializeOwnershipAt(uint256 index) internal virtual { if (_packedOwnerships[index] == 0) { _packedOwnerships[index] = _packedOwnershipOf(index); } } /** * Returns the packed ownership data of `tokenId`. */ function _packedOwnershipOf(uint256 tokenId) private view returns (uint256) { uint256 curr = tokenId; unchecked { if (_startTokenId() <= curr) if (curr < _currentIndex) { uint256 packed = _packedOwnerships[curr]; // If not burned. if (packed & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0) { // Invariant: // There will always be an initialized ownership slot // (i.e. `ownership.addr != address(0) && ownership.burned == false`) // before an unintialized ownership slot // (i.e. `ownership.addr == address(0) && ownership.burned == false`) // Hence, `curr` will not underflow. // // We can directly compare the packed value. // If the address is zero, packed will be zero. while (packed == 0) { packed = _packedOwnerships[--curr]; } return packed; } } } revert OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken(); } /** * @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct from `packed`. */ function _unpackedOwnership(uint256 packed) private pure returns (TokenOwnership memory ownership) { ownership.addr = address(uint160(packed)); ownership.startTimestamp = uint64(packed >> _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP); ownership.burned = packed & _BITMASK_BURNED != 0; ownership.extraData = uint24(packed >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA); } /** * @dev Packs ownership data into a single uint256. */ function _packOwnershipData(address owner, uint256 flags) private view returns (uint256 result) { assembly { // Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean. owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS) // `owner | (block.timestamp << _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP) | flags`. result := or(owner, or(shl(_BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP, timestamp()), flags)) } } /** * @dev Returns the `nextInitialized` flag set if `quantity` equals 1. */ function _nextInitializedFlag(uint256 quantity) private pure returns (uint256 result) { // For branchless setting of the `nextInitialized` flag. assembly { // `(quantity == 1) << _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED`. result := shl(_BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED, eq(quantity, 1)) } } // ============================================================= // APPROVAL OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account. * The approval is cleared when the token is transferred. * * Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the * zero address clears previous approvals. * * Requirements: * * - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator. * - `tokenId` must exist. * * Emits an {Approval} event. */ function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) public payable virtual override { address owner = ownerOf(tokenId); if (_msgSenderERC721A() != owner) if (!isApprovedForAll(owner, _msgSenderERC721A())) { revert ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved(); } _tokenApprovals[tokenId].value = to; emit Approval(owner, to, tokenId); } /** * @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. */ function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) { if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken(); return _tokenApprovals[tokenId].value; } /** * @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller. * Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom} * for any token owned by the caller. * * Requirements: * * - The `operator` cannot be the caller. * * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event. */ function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool approved) public virtual override { _operatorApprovals[_msgSenderERC721A()][operator] = approved; emit ApprovalForAll(_msgSenderERC721A(), operator, approved); } /** * @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`. * * See {setApprovalForAll}. */ function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) public view virtual override returns (bool) { return _operatorApprovals[owner][operator]; } /** * @dev Returns whether `tokenId` exists. * * Tokens can be managed by their owner or approved accounts via {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * * Tokens start existing when they are minted. See {_mint}. */ function _exists(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (bool) { return _startTokenId() <= tokenId && tokenId < _currentIndex && // If within bounds, _packedOwnerships[tokenId] & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0; // and not burned. } /** * @dev Returns whether `msgSender` is equal to `approvedAddress` or `owner`. */ function _isSenderApprovedOrOwner( address approvedAddress, address owner, address msgSender ) private pure returns (bool result) { assembly { // Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean. owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS) // Mask `msgSender` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean. msgSender := and(msgSender, _BITMASK_ADDRESS) // `msgSender == owner || msgSender == approvedAddress`. result := or(eq(msgSender, owner), eq(msgSender, approvedAddress)) } } /** * @dev Returns the storage slot and value for the approved address of `tokenId`. */ function _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(uint256 tokenId) private view returns (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) { TokenApprovalRef storage tokenApproval = _tokenApprovals[tokenId]; // The following is equivalent to `approvedAddress = _tokenApprovals[tokenId].value`. assembly { approvedAddressSlot := tokenApproval.slot approvedAddress := sload(approvedAddressSlot) } } // ============================================================= // TRANSFER OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`. * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token * by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) public payable virtual override { uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId); if (address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked)) != from) revert TransferFromIncorrectOwner(); (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId); // The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition. if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A())) if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) revert TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved(); if (to == address(0)) revert TransferToZeroAddress(); _beforeTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1); // Clear approvals from the previous owner. assembly { if approvedAddress { // This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`. sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0) } } // Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for // ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow. // Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256. unchecked { // We can directly increment and decrement the balances. --_packedAddressData[from]; // Updates: `balance -= 1`. ++_packedAddressData[to]; // Updates: `balance += 1`. // Updates: // - `address` to the next owner. // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of transfering. // - `burned` to `false`. // - `nextInitialized` to `true`. _packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData( to, _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED | _nextExtraData(from, to, prevOwnershipPacked) ); // If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) . if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) { uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1; // If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero). if (_packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) { // If the next slot is within bounds. if (nextTokenId != _currentIndex) { // Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`. _packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked; } } } } emit Transfer(from, to, tokenId); _afterTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1); } /** * @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`. */ function safeTransferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) public payable virtual override { safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, ''); } /** * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`. * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token * by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement * {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function safeTransferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes memory _data ) public payable virtual override { transferFrom(from, to, tokenId); if (to.code.length != 0) if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(from, to, tokenId, _data)) { revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer(); } } /** * @dev Hook that is called before a set of serially-ordered token IDs * are about to be transferred. This includes minting. * And also called before burning one token. * * `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred. * `quantity` - the amount to be transferred. * * Calling conditions: * * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be * transferred to `to`. * - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`. * - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`. * - `from` and `to` are never both zero. */ function _beforeTokenTransfers( address from, address to, uint256 startTokenId, uint256 quantity ) internal virtual {} /** * @dev Hook that is called after a set of serially-ordered token IDs * have been transferred. This includes minting. * And also called after one token has been burned. * * `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred. * `quantity` - the amount to be transferred. * * Calling conditions: * * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` has been * transferred to `to`. * - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` has been minted for `to`. * - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` has been burned by `from`. * - `from` and `to` are never both zero. */ function _afterTokenTransfers( address from, address to, uint256 startTokenId, uint256 quantity ) internal virtual {} /** * @dev Private function to invoke {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received} on a target contract. * * `from` - Previous owner of the given token ID. * `to` - Target address that will receive the token. * `tokenId` - Token ID to be transferred. * `_data` - Optional data to send along with the call. * * Returns whether the call correctly returned the expected magic value. */ function _checkContractOnERC721Received( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes memory _data ) private returns (bool) { try ERC721A__IERC721Receiver(to).onERC721Received(_msgSenderERC721A(), from, tokenId, _data) returns ( bytes4 retval ) { return retval == ERC721A__IERC721Receiver(to).onERC721Received.selector; } catch (bytes memory reason) { if (reason.length == 0) { revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer(); } else { assembly { revert(add(32, reason), mload(reason)) } } } } // ============================================================= // MINT OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`. * * Requirements: * * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `quantity` must be greater than 0. * * Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint. */ function _mint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual { uint256 startTokenId = _currentIndex; if (quantity == 0) revert MintZeroQuantity(); _beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity); // Overflows are incredibly unrealistic. // `balance` and `numberMinted` have a maximum limit of 2**64. // `tokenId` has a maximum limit of 2**256. unchecked { // Updates: // - `balance += quantity`. // - `numberMinted += quantity`. // // We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`. _packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1); // Updates: // - `address` to the owner. // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting. // - `burned` to `false`. // - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`. _packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData( to, _nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0) ); uint256 toMasked; uint256 end = startTokenId + quantity; // Use assembly to loop and emit the `Transfer` event for gas savings. // The duplicated `log4` removes an extra check and reduces stack juggling. // The assembly, together with the surrounding Solidity code, have been // delicately arranged to nudge the compiler into producing optimized opcodes. assembly { // Mask `to` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean. toMasked := and(to, _BITMASK_ADDRESS) // Emit the `Transfer` event. log4( 0, // Start of data (0, since no data). 0, // End of data (0, since no data). _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, // Signature. 0, // `address(0)`. toMasked, // `to`. startTokenId // `tokenId`. ) // The `iszero(eq(,))` check ensures that large values of `quantity` // that overflows uint256 will make the loop run out of gas. // The compiler will optimize the `iszero` away for performance. for { let tokenId := add(startTokenId, 1) } iszero(eq(tokenId, end)) { tokenId := add(tokenId, 1) } { // Emit the `Transfer` event. Similar to above. log4(0, 0, _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, 0, toMasked, tokenId) } } if (toMasked == 0) revert MintToZeroAddress(); _currentIndex = end; } _afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity); } /** * @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`. * * This function is intended for efficient minting only during contract creation. * * It emits only one {ConsecutiveTransfer} as defined in * [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309), * instead of a sequence of {Transfer} event(s). * * Calling this function outside of contract creation WILL make your contract * non-compliant with the ERC721 standard. * For full ERC721 compliance, substituting ERC721 {Transfer} event(s) with the ERC2309 * {ConsecutiveTransfer} event is only permissible during contract creation. * * Requirements: * * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `quantity` must be greater than 0. * * Emits a {ConsecutiveTransfer} event. */ function _mintERC2309(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual { uint256 startTokenId = _currentIndex; if (to == address(0)) revert MintToZeroAddress(); if (quantity == 0) revert MintZeroQuantity(); if (quantity > _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT) revert MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit(); _beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity); // Overflows are unrealistic due to the above check for `quantity` to be below the limit. unchecked { // Updates: // - `balance += quantity`. // - `numberMinted += quantity`. // // We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`. _packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1); // Updates: // - `address` to the owner. // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting. // - `burned` to `false`. // - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`. _packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData( to, _nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0) ); emit ConsecutiveTransfer(startTokenId, startTokenId + quantity - 1, address(0), to); _currentIndex = startTokenId + quantity; } _afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity); } /** * @dev Safely mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`. * * Requirements: * * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement * {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called for each safe transfer. * - `quantity` must be greater than 0. * * See {_mint}. * * Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint. */ function _safeMint( address to, uint256 quantity, bytes memory _data ) internal virtual { _mint(to, quantity); unchecked { if (to.code.length != 0) { uint256 end = _currentIndex; uint256 index = end - quantity; do { if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(address(0), to, index++, _data)) { revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer(); } } while (index < end); // Reentrancy protection. if (_currentIndex != end) revert(); } } } /** * @dev Equivalent to `_safeMint(to, quantity, '')`. */ function _safeMint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual { _safeMint(to, quantity, ''); } // ============================================================= // BURN OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Equivalent to `_burn(tokenId, false)`. */ function _burn(uint256 tokenId) internal virtual { _burn(tokenId, false); } /** * @dev Destroys `tokenId`. * The approval is cleared when the token is burned. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function _burn(uint256 tokenId, bool approvalCheck) internal virtual { uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId); address from = address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked)); (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId); if (approvalCheck) { // The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition. if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A())) if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) revert TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved(); } _beforeTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1); // Clear approvals from the previous owner. assembly { if approvedAddress { // This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`. sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0) } } // Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for // ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow. // Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256. unchecked { // Updates: // - `balance -= 1`. // - `numberBurned += 1`. // // We can directly decrement the balance, and increment the number burned. // This is equivalent to `packed -= 1; packed += 1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED;`. _packedAddressData[from] += (1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) - 1; // Updates: // - `address` to the last owner. // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of burning. // - `burned` to `true`. // - `nextInitialized` to `true`. _packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData( from, (_BITMASK_BURNED | _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED) | _nextExtraData(from, address(0), prevOwnershipPacked) ); // If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) . if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) { uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1; // If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero). if (_packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) { // If the next slot is within bounds. if (nextTokenId != _currentIndex) { // Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`. _packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked; } } } } emit Transfer(from, address(0), tokenId); _afterTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1); // Overflow not possible, as _burnCounter cannot be exceed _currentIndex times. unchecked { _burnCounter++; } } // ============================================================= // EXTRA DATA OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Directly sets the extra data for the ownership data `index`. */ function _setExtraDataAt(uint256 index, uint24 extraData) internal virtual { uint256 packed = _packedOwnerships[index]; if (packed == 0) revert OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData(); uint256 extraDataCasted; // Cast `extraData` with assembly to avoid redundant masking. assembly { extraDataCasted := extraData } packed = (packed & _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT) | (extraDataCasted << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA); _packedOwnerships[index] = packed; } /** * @dev Called during each token transfer to set the 24bit `extraData` field. * Intended to be overridden by the cosumer contract. * * `previousExtraData` - the value of `extraData` before transfer. * * Calling conditions: * * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be * transferred to `to`. * - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`. * - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`. * - `from` and `to` are never both zero. */ function _extraData( address from, address to, uint24 previousExtraData ) internal view virtual returns (uint24) {} /** * @dev Returns the next extra data for the packed ownership data. * The returned result is shifted into position. */ function _nextExtraData( address from, address to, uint256 prevOwnershipPacked ) private view returns (uint256) { uint24 extraData = uint24(prevOwnershipPacked >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA); return uint256(_extraData(from, to, extraData)) << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA; } // ============================================================= // OTHER OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the message sender (defaults to `msg.sender`). * * If you are writing GSN compatible contracts, you need to override this function. */ function _msgSenderERC721A() internal view virtual returns (address) { return msg.sender; } /** * @dev Converts a uint256 to its ASCII string decimal representation. */ function _toString(uint256 value) internal pure virtual returns (string memory str) { assembly { // The maximum value of a uint256 contains 78 digits (1 byte per digit), but // we allocate 0xa0 bytes to keep the free memory pointer 32-byte word aligned. // We will need 1 word for the trailing zeros padding, 1 word for the length, // and 3 words for a maximum of 78 digits. Total: 5 * 0x20 = 0xa0. let m := add(mload(0x40), 0xa0) // Update the free memory pointer to allocate. mstore(0x40, m) // Assign the `str` to the end. str := sub(m, 0x20) // Zeroize the slot after the string. mstore(str, 0) // Cache the end of the memory to calculate the length later. let end := str // We write the string from rightmost digit to leftmost digit. // The following is essentially a do-while loop that also handles the zero case. // prettier-ignore for { let temp := value } 1 {} { str := sub(str, 1) // Write the character to the pointer. // The ASCII index of the '0' character is 48. mstore8(str, add(48, mod(temp, 10))) // Keep dividing `temp` until zero. temp := div(temp, 10) // prettier-ignore if iszero(temp) { break } } let length := sub(end, str) // Move the pointer 32 bytes leftwards to make room for the length. str := sub(str, 0x20) // Store the length. mstore(str, length) } } } // File contracts/UnchainedMilady.sol pragma solidity ^0.8.17; contract UnchainedMilady is ERC721A, Ownable { uint256 public mintPrice = 0.044 ether; bool public saleIsActive = false; uint256 public maxPerAddressDuringMint = 100; string private _baseTokenURI; uint256 public maxSupply = 8888; mapping(address => bool) public mintedFree; address mezzanotteWallet = 0x4dDAc376f28BE60e1F7642A4D302C6Cf6CAe1D92; address devWallet = 0x67c724f54EEeaF679a62149AbeA6f067187731cd; modifier onlyDev() { require(msg.sender == devWallet, "Caller is not the dev"); _; } constructor() ERC721A("Unchained Milady", "UNMIL") {} function mintReserveTokens(uint256 numberOfTokens) public onlyDev { _safeMint(msg.sender, numberOfTokens); require(totalSupply() <= maxSupply, "Limit reached"); } function flipSaleState() public onlyDev { saleIsActive = !saleIsActive; } function setMintPrice(uint256 newPrice) public onlyDev { mintPrice = newPrice; } function setMaxSupply(uint256 newAmount) public onlyDev { maxSupply = newAmount; } function _baseURI() internal view virtual override returns (string memory) { return _baseTokenURI; } function setBaseURI(string calldata baseURI) external onlyDev { _baseTokenURI = baseURI; } function mint(uint256 quantity) external payable { require(saleIsActive, "Sale must be active to mint"); require( quantity <= maxPerAddressDuringMint, "You can't mint that many at once" ); require( mintPrice * quantity <= msg.value, "Ether value sent is not correct" ); _mint(msg.sender, quantity); require(totalSupply() <= maxSupply, "Limit reached"); } function freeMint() external payable { require(saleIsActive, "Sale must be active to mint"); require( isAFriend(msg.sender), "This wallet doesn't hold any friend NFTs" ); require( mintedFree[msg.sender] == false, "You can only mint 1 for free" ); mintedFree[msg.sender] = true; _mint(msg.sender, 1); require(totalSupply() <= maxSupply, "Limit reached"); } function isAFriend(address addr) public view returns (bool) { address milady = 0x5Af0D9827E0c53E4799BB226655A1de152A425a5; address ssrwives = 0x64256b6409150e8B2B25A456A17DCf171209542a; address angelbanners = 0xB1224F5E241424458E87c14652CFe59662BF3A9A; address aura = 0x2fC722C1c77170A61F17962CC4D039692f033b43; // Mezzanotte projects: address whitehearts = 0x4577fcfB0642afD21b5f2502753ED6D497B830E9; address simPackTwo = 0x243d558472eF7030aFe3675Bb0a6f9Fb7cE39E13; address simPackOne = 0x8b6DCfB251bef4953cF3f3A8C66Af870e6b7466e; address dropicall = 0x8b82D758a95c84Bc5476244f91e9AC6478d2a8B0; return IERC721(milady).balanceOf(addr) > 0 || IERC721(ssrwives).balanceOf(addr) > 0 || IERC721(angelbanners).balanceOf(addr) > 0 || IERC721(aura).balanceOf(addr) > 0 || IERC721(whitehearts).balanceOf(addr) > 0 || IERC721(simPackTwo).balanceOf(addr) > 0 || IERC721(simPackOne).balanceOf(addr) > 0 || IERC721(dropicall).balanceOf(addr) > 0; } function withdrawMoney() external onlyDev { (bool success, ) = devWallet.call{value: address(this).balance}(""); require(success, "Transfer failed."); } function withdrawSplit() public payable onlyOwner { uint256 tenth = address(this).balance / 10; require(payable(devWallet).send(tenth)); require(payable(mezzanotteWallet).send(9 * tenth)); } }
File 2 of 5: Miladys
// File: @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/Context.sol // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity >=0.6.0 <0.8.0; /* * @dev Provides information about the current execution context, including the * sender of the transaction and its data. While these are generally available * via msg.sender and msg.data, they should not be accessed in such a direct * manner, since when dealing with GSN meta-transactions the account sending and * paying for execution may not be the actual sender (as far as an application * is concerned). * * This contract is only required for intermediate, library-like contracts. */ abstract contract Context { function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address payable) { return msg.sender; } function _msgData() internal view virtual returns (bytes memory) { this; // silence state mutability warning without generating bytecode - see https://github.com/ethereum/solidity/issues/2691 return msg.data; } } // File: @openzeppelin/contracts/introspection/IERC165.sol pragma solidity >=0.6.0 <0.8.0; /** * @dev Interface of the ERC165 standard, as defined in the * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165[EIP]. * * Implementers can declare support of contract interfaces, which can then be * queried by others ({ERC165Checker}). * * For an implementation, see {ERC165}. */ interface IERC165 { /** * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified[EIP section] * to learn more about how these ids are created. * * This function call must use less than 30 000 gas. */ function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool); } // File: @openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/IERC721.sol pragma solidity >=0.6.2 <0.8.0; /** * @dev Required interface of an ERC721 compliant contract. */ interface IERC721 is IERC165 { /** * @dev Emitted when `tokenId` token is transferred from `from` to `to`. */ event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 indexed tokenId); /** * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables `approved` to manage the `tokenId` token. */ event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed approved, uint256 indexed tokenId); /** * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables or disables (`approved`) `operator` to manage all of its assets. */ event ApprovalForAll(address indexed owner, address indexed operator, bool approved); /** * @dev Returns the number of tokens in ``owner``'s account. */ function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256 balance); /** * @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. */ function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address owner); /** * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`, checking first that contract recipients * are aware of the ERC721 protocol to prevent tokens from being forever locked. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`. * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be have been allowed to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function safeTransferFrom(address from, address to, uint256 tokenId) external; /** * @dev Transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`. * * WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {safeTransferFrom} whenever possible. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`. * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transferFrom(address from, address to, uint256 tokenId) external; /** * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account. * The approval is cleared when the token is transferred. * * Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the zero address clears previous approvals. * * Requirements: * * - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator. * - `tokenId` must exist. * * Emits an {Approval} event. */ function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) external; /** * @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. */ function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address operator); /** * @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller. * Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom} for any token owned by the caller. * * Requirements: * * - The `operator` cannot be the caller. * * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event. */ function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool _approved) external; /** * @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`. * * See {setApprovalForAll} */ function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) external view returns (bool); /** * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`. * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function safeTransferFrom(address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes calldata data) external; } // File: @openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/IERC721Metadata.sol pragma solidity >=0.6.2 <0.8.0; /** * @title ERC-721 Non-Fungible Token Standard, optional metadata extension * @dev See https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-721 */ interface IERC721Metadata is IERC721 { /** * @dev Returns the token collection name. */ function name() external view returns (string memory); /** * @dev Returns the token collection symbol. */ function symbol() external view returns (string memory); /** * @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token. */ function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (string memory); } // File: @openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/IERC721Enumerable.sol pragma solidity >=0.6.2 <0.8.0; /** * @title ERC-721 Non-Fungible Token Standard, optional enumeration extension * @dev See https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-721 */ interface IERC721Enumerable is IERC721 { /** * @dev Returns the total amount of tokens stored by the contract. */ function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Returns a token ID owned by `owner` at a given `index` of its token list. * Use along with {balanceOf} to enumerate all of ``owner``'s tokens. */ function tokenOfOwnerByIndex(address owner, uint256 index) external view returns (uint256 tokenId); /** * @dev Returns a token ID at a given `index` of all the tokens stored by the contract. * Use along with {totalSupply} to enumerate all tokens. */ function tokenByIndex(uint256 index) external view returns (uint256); } // File: @openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/IERC721Receiver.sol pragma solidity >=0.6.0 <0.8.0; /** * @title ERC721 token receiver interface * @dev Interface for any contract that wants to support safeTransfers * from ERC721 asset contracts. */ interface IERC721Receiver { /** * @dev Whenever an {IERC721} `tokenId` token is transferred to this contract via {IERC721-safeTransferFrom} * by `operator` from `from`, this function is called. * * It must return its Solidity selector to confirm the token transfer. * If any other value is returned or the interface is not implemented by the recipient, the transfer will be reverted. * * The selector can be obtained in Solidity with `IERC721.onERC721Received.selector`. */ function onERC721Received(address operator, address from, uint256 tokenId, bytes calldata data) external returns (bytes4); } // File: @openzeppelin/contracts/introspection/ERC165.sol pragma solidity >=0.6.0 <0.8.0; /** * @dev Implementation of the {IERC165} interface. * * Contracts may inherit from this and call {_registerInterface} to declare * their support of an interface. */ abstract contract ERC165 is IERC165 { /* * bytes4(keccak256('supportsInterface(bytes4)')) == 0x01ffc9a7 */ bytes4 private constant _INTERFACE_ID_ERC165 = 0x01ffc9a7; /** * @dev Mapping of interface ids to whether or not it's supported. */ mapping(bytes4 => bool) private _supportedInterfaces; constructor () internal { // Derived contracts need only register support for their own interfaces, // we register support for ERC165 itself here _registerInterface(_INTERFACE_ID_ERC165); } /** * @dev See {IERC165-supportsInterface}. * * Time complexity O(1), guaranteed to always use less than 30 000 gas. */ function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) { return _supportedInterfaces[interfaceId]; } /** * @dev Registers the contract as an implementer of the interface defined by * `interfaceId`. Support of the actual ERC165 interface is automatic and * registering its interface id is not required. * * See {IERC165-supportsInterface}. * * Requirements: * * - `interfaceId` cannot be the ERC165 invalid interface (`0xffffffff`). */ function _registerInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) internal virtual { require(interfaceId != 0xffffffff, "ERC165: invalid interface id"); _supportedInterfaces[interfaceId] = true; } } // File: @openzeppelin/contracts/math/SafeMath.sol pragma solidity >=0.6.0 <0.8.0; /** * @dev Wrappers over Solidity's arithmetic operations with added overflow * checks. * * Arithmetic operations in Solidity wrap on overflow. This can easily result * in bugs, because programmers usually assume that an overflow raises an * error, which is the standard behavior in high level programming languages. * `SafeMath` restores this intuition by reverting the transaction when an * operation overflows. * * Using this library instead of the unchecked operations eliminates an entire * class of bugs, so it's recommended to use it always. */ library SafeMath { /** * @dev Returns the addition of two unsigned integers, with an overflow flag. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ function tryAdd(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) { uint256 c = a + b; if (c < a) return (false, 0); return (true, c); } /** * @dev Returns the substraction of two unsigned integers, with an overflow flag. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ function trySub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) { if (b > a) return (false, 0); return (true, a - b); } /** * @dev Returns the multiplication of two unsigned integers, with an overflow flag. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ function tryMul(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) { // Gas optimization: this is cheaper than requiring 'a' not being zero, but the // benefit is lost if 'b' is also tested. // See: https://github.com/OpenZeppelin/openzeppelin-contracts/pull/522 if (a == 0) return (true, 0); uint256 c = a * b; if (c / a != b) return (false, 0); return (true, c); } /** * @dev Returns the division of two unsigned integers, with a division by zero flag. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ function tryDiv(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) { if (b == 0) return (false, 0); return (true, a / b); } /** * @dev Returns the remainder of dividing two unsigned integers, with a division by zero flag. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ function tryMod(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) { if (b == 0) return (false, 0); return (true, a % b); } /** * @dev Returns the addition of two unsigned integers, reverting on * overflow. * * Counterpart to Solidity's `+` operator. * * Requirements: * * - Addition cannot overflow. */ function add(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 c = a + b; require(c >= a, "SafeMath: addition overflow"); return c; } /** * @dev Returns the subtraction of two unsigned integers, reverting on * overflow (when the result is negative). * * Counterpart to Solidity's `-` operator. * * Requirements: * * - Subtraction cannot overflow. */ function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { require(b <= a, "SafeMath: subtraction overflow"); return a - b; } /** * @dev Returns the multiplication of two unsigned integers, reverting on * overflow. * * Counterpart to Solidity's `*` operator. * * Requirements: * * - Multiplication cannot overflow. */ function mul(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { if (a == 0) return 0; uint256 c = a * b; require(c / a == b, "SafeMath: multiplication overflow"); return c; } /** * @dev Returns the integer division of two unsigned integers, reverting on * division by zero. The result is rounded towards zero. * * Counterpart to Solidity's `/` operator. Note: this function uses a * `revert` opcode (which leaves remaining gas untouched) while Solidity * uses an invalid opcode to revert (consuming all remaining gas). * * Requirements: * * - The divisor cannot be zero. */ function div(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { require(b > 0, "SafeMath: division by zero"); return a / b; } /** * @dev Returns the remainder of dividing two unsigned integers. (unsigned integer modulo), * reverting when dividing by zero. * * Counterpart to Solidity's `%` operator. This function uses a `revert` * opcode (which leaves remaining gas untouched) while Solidity uses an * invalid opcode to revert (consuming all remaining gas). * * Requirements: * * - The divisor cannot be zero. */ function mod(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { require(b > 0, "SafeMath: modulo by zero"); return a % b; } /** * @dev Returns the subtraction of two unsigned integers, reverting with custom message on * overflow (when the result is negative). * * CAUTION: This function is deprecated because it requires allocating memory for the error * message unnecessarily. For custom revert reasons use {trySub}. * * Counterpart to Solidity's `-` operator. * * Requirements: * * - Subtraction cannot overflow. */ function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b, string memory errorMessage) internal pure returns (uint256) { require(b <= a, errorMessage); return a - b; } /** * @dev Returns the integer division of two unsigned integers, reverting with custom message on * division by zero. The result is rounded towards zero. * * CAUTION: This function is deprecated because it requires allocating memory for the error * message unnecessarily. For custom revert reasons use {tryDiv}. * * Counterpart to Solidity's `/` operator. Note: this function uses a * `revert` opcode (which leaves remaining gas untouched) while Solidity * uses an invalid opcode to revert (consuming all remaining gas). * * Requirements: * * - The divisor cannot be zero. */ function div(uint256 a, uint256 b, string memory errorMessage) internal pure returns (uint256) { require(b > 0, errorMessage); return a / b; } /** * @dev Returns the remainder of dividing two unsigned integers. (unsigned integer modulo), * reverting with custom message when dividing by zero. * * CAUTION: This function is deprecated because it requires allocating memory for the error * message unnecessarily. For custom revert reasons use {tryMod}. * * Counterpart to Solidity's `%` operator. This function uses a `revert` * opcode (which leaves remaining gas untouched) while Solidity uses an * invalid opcode to revert (consuming all remaining gas). * * Requirements: * * - The divisor cannot be zero. */ function mod(uint256 a, uint256 b, string memory errorMessage) internal pure returns (uint256) { require(b > 0, errorMessage); return a % b; } } // File: @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/Address.sol pragma solidity >=0.6.2 <0.8.0; /** * @dev Collection of functions related to the address type */ library Address { /** * @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract. * * [IMPORTANT] * ==== * It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns * false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract. * * Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following * types of addresses: * * - an externally-owned account * - a contract in construction * - an address where a contract will be created * - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed * ==== */ function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) { // This method relies on extcodesize, which returns 0 for contracts in // construction, since the code is only stored at the end of the // constructor execution. uint256 size; // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { size := extcodesize(account) } return size > 0; } /** * @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to * `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors. * * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost * of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit * imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via * `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation. * * https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more]. * * IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be * taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using * {ReentrancyGuard} or the * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern]. */ function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal { require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance"); // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls, avoid-call-value (bool success, ) = recipient.call{ value: amount }(""); require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted"); } /** * @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A * plain`call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this * function instead. * * If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this * function (like regular Solidity function calls). * * Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value, * use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`]. * * Requirements: * * - `target` must be a contract. * - calling `target` with `data` must not revert. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) { return functionCall(target, data, "Address: low-level call failed"); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with * `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage) internal returns (bytes memory) { return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], * but also transferring `value` wei to `target`. * * Requirements: * * - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`. * - the called Solidity function must be `payable`. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCallWithValue(address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value) internal returns (bytes memory) { return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed"); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but * with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCallWithValue(address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value, string memory errorMessage) internal returns (bytes memory) { require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call"); require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract"); // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{ value: value }(data); return _verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], * but performing a static call. * * _Available since v3.3._ */ function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) { return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed"); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`], * but performing a static call. * * _Available since v3.3._ */ function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage) internal view returns (bytes memory) { require(isContract(target), "Address: static call to non-contract"); // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data); return _verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], * but performing a delegate call. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) { return functionDelegateCall(target, data, "Address: low-level delegate call failed"); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`], * but performing a delegate call. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage) internal returns (bytes memory) { require(isContract(target), "Address: delegate call to non-contract"); // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.delegatecall(data); return _verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage); } function _verifyCallResult(bool success, bytes memory returndata, string memory errorMessage) private pure returns(bytes memory) { if (success) { return returndata; } else { // Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present if (returndata.length > 0) { // The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { let returndata_size := mload(returndata) revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size) } } else { revert(errorMessage); } } } } // File: @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/EnumerableSet.sol pragma solidity >=0.6.0 <0.8.0; /** * @dev Library for managing * https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Set_(abstract_data_type)[sets] of primitive * types. * * Sets have the following properties: * * - Elements are added, removed, and checked for existence in constant time * (O(1)). * - Elements are enumerated in O(n). No guarantees are made on the ordering. * * ``` * contract Example { * // Add the library methods * using EnumerableSet for EnumerableSet.AddressSet; * * // Declare a set state variable * EnumerableSet.AddressSet private mySet; * } * ``` * * As of v3.3.0, sets of type `bytes32` (`Bytes32Set`), `address` (`AddressSet`) * and `uint256` (`UintSet`) are supported. */ library EnumerableSet { // To implement this library for multiple types with as little code // repetition as possible, we write it in terms of a generic Set type with // bytes32 values. // The Set implementation uses private functions, and user-facing // implementations (such as AddressSet) are just wrappers around the // underlying Set. // This means that we can only create new EnumerableSets for types that fit // in bytes32. struct Set { // Storage of set values bytes32[] _values; // Position of the value in the `values` array, plus 1 because index 0 // means a value is not in the set. mapping (bytes32 => uint256) _indexes; } /** * @dev Add a value to a set. O(1). * * Returns true if the value was added to the set, that is if it was not * already present. */ function _add(Set storage set, bytes32 value) private returns (bool) { if (!_contains(set, value)) { set._values.push(value); // The value is stored at length-1, but we add 1 to all indexes // and use 0 as a sentinel value set._indexes[value] = set._values.length; return true; } else { return false; } } /** * @dev Removes a value from a set. O(1). * * Returns true if the value was removed from the set, that is if it was * present. */ function _remove(Set storage set, bytes32 value) private returns (bool) { // We read and store the value's index to prevent multiple reads from the same storage slot uint256 valueIndex = set._indexes[value]; if (valueIndex != 0) { // Equivalent to contains(set, value) // To delete an element from the _values array in O(1), we swap the element to delete with the last one in // the array, and then remove the last element (sometimes called as 'swap and pop'). // This modifies the order of the array, as noted in {at}. uint256 toDeleteIndex = valueIndex - 1; uint256 lastIndex = set._values.length - 1; // When the value to delete is the last one, the swap operation is unnecessary. However, since this occurs // so rarely, we still do the swap anyway to avoid the gas cost of adding an 'if' statement. bytes32 lastvalue = set._values[lastIndex]; // Move the last value to the index where the value to delete is set._values[toDeleteIndex] = lastvalue; // Update the index for the moved value set._indexes[lastvalue] = toDeleteIndex + 1; // All indexes are 1-based // Delete the slot where the moved value was stored set._values.pop(); // Delete the index for the deleted slot delete set._indexes[value]; return true; } else { return false; } } /** * @dev Returns true if the value is in the set. O(1). */ function _contains(Set storage set, bytes32 value) private view returns (bool) { return set._indexes[value] != 0; } /** * @dev Returns the number of values on the set. O(1). */ function _length(Set storage set) private view returns (uint256) { return set._values.length; } /** * @dev Returns the value stored at position `index` in the set. O(1). * * Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of values inside the * array, and it may change when more values are added or removed. * * Requirements: * * - `index` must be strictly less than {length}. */ function _at(Set storage set, uint256 index) private view returns (bytes32) { require(set._values.length > index, "EnumerableSet: index out of bounds"); return set._values[index]; } // Bytes32Set struct Bytes32Set { Set _inner; } /** * @dev Add a value to a set. O(1). * * Returns true if the value was added to the set, that is if it was not * already present. */ function add(Bytes32Set storage set, bytes32 value) internal returns (bool) { return _add(set._inner, value); } /** * @dev Removes a value from a set. O(1). * * Returns true if the value was removed from the set, that is if it was * present. */ function remove(Bytes32Set storage set, bytes32 value) internal returns (bool) { return _remove(set._inner, value); } /** * @dev Returns true if the value is in the set. O(1). */ function contains(Bytes32Set storage set, bytes32 value) internal view returns (bool) { return _contains(set._inner, value); } /** * @dev Returns the number of values in the set. O(1). */ function length(Bytes32Set storage set) internal view returns (uint256) { return _length(set._inner); } /** * @dev Returns the value stored at position `index` in the set. O(1). * * Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of values inside the * array, and it may change when more values are added or removed. * * Requirements: * * - `index` must be strictly less than {length}. */ function at(Bytes32Set storage set, uint256 index) internal view returns (bytes32) { return _at(set._inner, index); } // AddressSet struct AddressSet { Set _inner; } /** * @dev Add a value to a set. O(1). * * Returns true if the value was added to the set, that is if it was not * already present. */ function add(AddressSet storage set, address value) internal returns (bool) { return _add(set._inner, bytes32(uint256(uint160(value)))); } /** * @dev Removes a value from a set. O(1). * * Returns true if the value was removed from the set, that is if it was * present. */ function remove(AddressSet storage set, address value) internal returns (bool) { return _remove(set._inner, bytes32(uint256(uint160(value)))); } /** * @dev Returns true if the value is in the set. O(1). */ function contains(AddressSet storage set, address value) internal view returns (bool) { return _contains(set._inner, bytes32(uint256(uint160(value)))); } /** * @dev Returns the number of values in the set. O(1). */ function length(AddressSet storage set) internal view returns (uint256) { return _length(set._inner); } /** * @dev Returns the value stored at position `index` in the set. O(1). * * Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of values inside the * array, and it may change when more values are added or removed. * * Requirements: * * - `index` must be strictly less than {length}. */ function at(AddressSet storage set, uint256 index) internal view returns (address) { return address(uint160(uint256(_at(set._inner, index)))); } // UintSet struct UintSet { Set _inner; } /** * @dev Add a value to a set. O(1). * * Returns true if the value was added to the set, that is if it was not * already present. */ function add(UintSet storage set, uint256 value) internal returns (bool) { return _add(set._inner, bytes32(value)); } /** * @dev Removes a value from a set. O(1). * * Returns true if the value was removed from the set, that is if it was * present. */ function remove(UintSet storage set, uint256 value) internal returns (bool) { return _remove(set._inner, bytes32(value)); } /** * @dev Returns true if the value is in the set. O(1). */ function contains(UintSet storage set, uint256 value) internal view returns (bool) { return _contains(set._inner, bytes32(value)); } /** * @dev Returns the number of values on the set. O(1). */ function length(UintSet storage set) internal view returns (uint256) { return _length(set._inner); } /** * @dev Returns the value stored at position `index` in the set. O(1). * * Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of values inside the * array, and it may change when more values are added or removed. * * Requirements: * * - `index` must be strictly less than {length}. */ function at(UintSet storage set, uint256 index) internal view returns (uint256) { return uint256(_at(set._inner, index)); } } // File: @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/EnumerableMap.sol pragma solidity >=0.6.0 <0.8.0; /** * @dev Library for managing an enumerable variant of Solidity's * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/types.html#mapping-types[`mapping`] * type. * * Maps have the following properties: * * - Entries are added, removed, and checked for existence in constant time * (O(1)). * - Entries are enumerated in O(n). No guarantees are made on the ordering. * * ``` * contract Example { * // Add the library methods * using EnumerableMap for EnumerableMap.UintToAddressMap; * * // Declare a set state variable * EnumerableMap.UintToAddressMap private myMap; * } * ``` * * As of v3.0.0, only maps of type `uint256 -> address` (`UintToAddressMap`) are * supported. */ library EnumerableMap { // To implement this library for multiple types with as little code // repetition as possible, we write it in terms of a generic Map type with // bytes32 keys and values. // The Map implementation uses private functions, and user-facing // implementations (such as Uint256ToAddressMap) are just wrappers around // the underlying Map. // This means that we can only create new EnumerableMaps for types that fit // in bytes32. struct MapEntry { bytes32 _key; bytes32 _value; } struct Map { // Storage of map keys and values MapEntry[] _entries; // Position of the entry defined by a key in the `entries` array, plus 1 // because index 0 means a key is not in the map. mapping (bytes32 => uint256) _indexes; } /** * @dev Adds a key-value pair to a map, or updates the value for an existing * key. O(1). * * Returns true if the key was added to the map, that is if it was not * already present. */ function _set(Map storage map, bytes32 key, bytes32 value) private returns (bool) { // We read and store the key's index to prevent multiple reads from the same storage slot uint256 keyIndex = map._indexes[key]; if (keyIndex == 0) { // Equivalent to !contains(map, key) map._entries.push(MapEntry({ _key: key, _value: value })); // The entry is stored at length-1, but we add 1 to all indexes // and use 0 as a sentinel value map._indexes[key] = map._entries.length; return true; } else { map._entries[keyIndex - 1]._value = value; return false; } } /** * @dev Removes a key-value pair from a map. O(1). * * Returns true if the key was removed from the map, that is if it was present. */ function _remove(Map storage map, bytes32 key) private returns (bool) { // We read and store the key's index to prevent multiple reads from the same storage slot uint256 keyIndex = map._indexes[key]; if (keyIndex != 0) { // Equivalent to contains(map, key) // To delete a key-value pair from the _entries array in O(1), we swap the entry to delete with the last one // in the array, and then remove the last entry (sometimes called as 'swap and pop'). // This modifies the order of the array, as noted in {at}. uint256 toDeleteIndex = keyIndex - 1; uint256 lastIndex = map._entries.length - 1; // When the entry to delete is the last one, the swap operation is unnecessary. However, since this occurs // so rarely, we still do the swap anyway to avoid the gas cost of adding an 'if' statement. MapEntry storage lastEntry = map._entries[lastIndex]; // Move the last entry to the index where the entry to delete is map._entries[toDeleteIndex] = lastEntry; // Update the index for the moved entry map._indexes[lastEntry._key] = toDeleteIndex + 1; // All indexes are 1-based // Delete the slot where the moved entry was stored map._entries.pop(); // Delete the index for the deleted slot delete map._indexes[key]; return true; } else { return false; } } /** * @dev Returns true if the key is in the map. O(1). */ function _contains(Map storage map, bytes32 key) private view returns (bool) { return map._indexes[key] != 0; } /** * @dev Returns the number of key-value pairs in the map. O(1). */ function _length(Map storage map) private view returns (uint256) { return map._entries.length; } /** * @dev Returns the key-value pair stored at position `index` in the map. O(1). * * Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of entries inside the * array, and it may change when more entries are added or removed. * * Requirements: * * - `index` must be strictly less than {length}. */ function _at(Map storage map, uint256 index) private view returns (bytes32, bytes32) { require(map._entries.length > index, "EnumerableMap: index out of bounds"); MapEntry storage entry = map._entries[index]; return (entry._key, entry._value); } /** * @dev Tries to returns the value associated with `key`. O(1). * Does not revert if `key` is not in the map. */ function _tryGet(Map storage map, bytes32 key) private view returns (bool, bytes32) { uint256 keyIndex = map._indexes[key]; if (keyIndex == 0) return (false, 0); // Equivalent to contains(map, key) return (true, map._entries[keyIndex - 1]._value); // All indexes are 1-based } /** * @dev Returns the value associated with `key`. O(1). * * Requirements: * * - `key` must be in the map. */ function _get(Map storage map, bytes32 key) private view returns (bytes32) { uint256 keyIndex = map._indexes[key]; require(keyIndex != 0, "EnumerableMap: nonexistent key"); // Equivalent to contains(map, key) return map._entries[keyIndex - 1]._value; // All indexes are 1-based } /** * @dev Same as {_get}, with a custom error message when `key` is not in the map. * * CAUTION: This function is deprecated because it requires allocating memory for the error * message unnecessarily. For custom revert reasons use {_tryGet}. */ function _get(Map storage map, bytes32 key, string memory errorMessage) private view returns (bytes32) { uint256 keyIndex = map._indexes[key]; require(keyIndex != 0, errorMessage); // Equivalent to contains(map, key) return map._entries[keyIndex - 1]._value; // All indexes are 1-based } // UintToAddressMap struct UintToAddressMap { Map _inner; } /** * @dev Adds a key-value pair to a map, or updates the value for an existing * key. O(1). * * Returns true if the key was added to the map, that is if it was not * already present. */ function set(UintToAddressMap storage map, uint256 key, address value) internal returns (bool) { return _set(map._inner, bytes32(key), bytes32(uint256(uint160(value)))); } /** * @dev Removes a value from a set. O(1). * * Returns true if the key was removed from the map, that is if it was present. */ function remove(UintToAddressMap storage map, uint256 key) internal returns (bool) { return _remove(map._inner, bytes32(key)); } /** * @dev Returns true if the key is in the map. O(1). */ function contains(UintToAddressMap storage map, uint256 key) internal view returns (bool) { return _contains(map._inner, bytes32(key)); } /** * @dev Returns the number of elements in the map. O(1). */ function length(UintToAddressMap storage map) internal view returns (uint256) { return _length(map._inner); } /** * @dev Returns the element stored at position `index` in the set. O(1). * Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of values inside the * array, and it may change when more values are added or removed. * * Requirements: * * - `index` must be strictly less than {length}. */ function at(UintToAddressMap storage map, uint256 index) internal view returns (uint256, address) { (bytes32 key, bytes32 value) = _at(map._inner, index); return (uint256(key), address(uint160(uint256(value)))); } /** * @dev Tries to returns the value associated with `key`. O(1). * Does not revert if `key` is not in the map. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ function tryGet(UintToAddressMap storage map, uint256 key) internal view returns (bool, address) { (bool success, bytes32 value) = _tryGet(map._inner, bytes32(key)); return (success, address(uint160(uint256(value)))); } /** * @dev Returns the value associated with `key`. O(1). * * Requirements: * * - `key` must be in the map. */ function get(UintToAddressMap storage map, uint256 key) internal view returns (address) { return address(uint160(uint256(_get(map._inner, bytes32(key))))); } /** * @dev Same as {get}, with a custom error message when `key` is not in the map. * * CAUTION: This function is deprecated because it requires allocating memory for the error * message unnecessarily. For custom revert reasons use {tryGet}. */ function get(UintToAddressMap storage map, uint256 key, string memory errorMessage) internal view returns (address) { return address(uint160(uint256(_get(map._inner, bytes32(key), errorMessage)))); } } // File: @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/Strings.sol pragma solidity >=0.6.0 <0.8.0; /** * @dev String operations. */ library Strings { /** * @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` representation. */ function toString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) { // Inspired by OraclizeAPI's implementation - MIT licence // https://github.com/oraclize/ethereum-api/blob/b42146b063c7d6ee1358846c198246239e9360e8/oraclizeAPI_0.4.25.sol if (value == 0) { return "0"; } uint256 temp = value; uint256 digits; while (temp != 0) { digits++; temp /= 10; } bytes memory buffer = new bytes(digits); uint256 index = digits - 1; temp = value; while (temp != 0) { buffer[index--] = bytes1(uint8(48 + temp % 10)); temp /= 10; } return string(buffer); } } // File: @openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/ERC721.sol pragma solidity >=0.6.0 <0.8.0; /** * @title ERC721 Non-Fungible Token Standard basic implementation * @dev see https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-721 */ contract ERC721 is Context, ERC165, IERC721, IERC721Metadata, IERC721Enumerable { using SafeMath for uint256; using Address for address; using EnumerableSet for EnumerableSet.UintSet; using EnumerableMap for EnumerableMap.UintToAddressMap; using Strings for uint256; // Equals to `bytes4(keccak256("onERC721Received(address,address,uint256,bytes)"))` // which can be also obtained as `IERC721Receiver(0).onERC721Received.selector` bytes4 private constant _ERC721_RECEIVED = 0x150b7a02; // Mapping from holder address to their (enumerable) set of owned tokens mapping (address => EnumerableSet.UintSet) private _holderTokens; // Enumerable mapping from token ids to their owners EnumerableMap.UintToAddressMap private _tokenOwners; // Mapping from token ID to approved address mapping (uint256 => address) private _tokenApprovals; // Mapping from owner to operator approvals mapping (address => mapping (address => bool)) private _operatorApprovals; // Token name string private _name; // Token symbol string private _symbol; // Optional mapping for token URIs mapping (uint256 => string) private _tokenURIs; // Base URI string private _baseURI; /* * bytes4(keccak256('balanceOf(address)')) == 0x70a08231 * bytes4(keccak256('ownerOf(uint256)')) == 0x6352211e * bytes4(keccak256('approve(address,uint256)')) == 0x095ea7b3 * bytes4(keccak256('getApproved(uint256)')) == 0x081812fc * bytes4(keccak256('setApprovalForAll(address,bool)')) == 0xa22cb465 * bytes4(keccak256('isApprovedForAll(address,address)')) == 0xe985e9c5 * bytes4(keccak256('transferFrom(address,address,uint256)')) == 0x23b872dd * bytes4(keccak256('safeTransferFrom(address,address,uint256)')) == 0x42842e0e * bytes4(keccak256('safeTransferFrom(address,address,uint256,bytes)')) == 0xb88d4fde * * => 0x70a08231 ^ 0x6352211e ^ 0x095ea7b3 ^ 0x081812fc ^ * 0xa22cb465 ^ 0xe985e9c5 ^ 0x23b872dd ^ 0x42842e0e ^ 0xb88d4fde == 0x80ac58cd */ bytes4 private constant _INTERFACE_ID_ERC721 = 0x80ac58cd; /* * bytes4(keccak256('name()')) == 0x06fdde03 * bytes4(keccak256('symbol()')) == 0x95d89b41 * bytes4(keccak256('tokenURI(uint256)')) == 0xc87b56dd * * => 0x06fdde03 ^ 0x95d89b41 ^ 0xc87b56dd == 0x5b5e139f */ bytes4 private constant _INTERFACE_ID_ERC721_METADATA = 0x5b5e139f; /* * bytes4(keccak256('totalSupply()')) == 0x18160ddd * bytes4(keccak256('tokenOfOwnerByIndex(address,uint256)')) == 0x2f745c59 * bytes4(keccak256('tokenByIndex(uint256)')) == 0x4f6ccce7 * * => 0x18160ddd ^ 0x2f745c59 ^ 0x4f6ccce7 == 0x780e9d63 */ bytes4 private constant _INTERFACE_ID_ERC721_ENUMERABLE = 0x780e9d63; /** * @dev Initializes the contract by setting a `name` and a `symbol` to the token collection. */ constructor (string memory name_, string memory symbol_) public { _name = name_; _symbol = symbol_; // register the supported interfaces to conform to ERC721 via ERC165 _registerInterface(_INTERFACE_ID_ERC721); _registerInterface(_INTERFACE_ID_ERC721_METADATA); _registerInterface(_INTERFACE_ID_ERC721_ENUMERABLE); } /** * @dev See {IERC721-balanceOf}. */ function balanceOf(address owner) public view virtual override returns (uint256) { require(owner != address(0), "ERC721: balance query for the zero address"); return _holderTokens[owner].length(); } /** * @dev See {IERC721-ownerOf}. */ function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) { return _tokenOwners.get(tokenId, "ERC721: owner query for nonexistent token"); } /** * @dev See {IERC721Metadata-name}. */ function name() public view virtual override returns (string memory) { return _name; } /** * @dev See {IERC721Metadata-symbol}. */ function symbol() public view virtual override returns (string memory) { return _symbol; } /** * @dev See {IERC721Metadata-tokenURI}. */ function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (string memory) { require(_exists(tokenId), "ERC721Metadata: URI query for nonexistent token"); string memory _tokenURI = _tokenURIs[tokenId]; string memory base = baseURI(); // If there is no base URI, return the token URI. if (bytes(base).length == 0) { return _tokenURI; } // If both are set, concatenate the baseURI and tokenURI (via abi.encodePacked). if (bytes(_tokenURI).length > 0) { return string(abi.encodePacked(base, _tokenURI)); } // If there is a baseURI but no tokenURI, concatenate the tokenID to the baseURI. return string(abi.encodePacked(base, tokenId.toString())); } /** * @dev Returns the base URI set via {_setBaseURI}. This will be * automatically added as a prefix in {tokenURI} to each token's URI, or * to the token ID if no specific URI is set for that token ID. */ function baseURI() public view virtual returns (string memory) { return _baseURI; } /** * @dev See {IERC721Enumerable-tokenOfOwnerByIndex}. */ function tokenOfOwnerByIndex(address owner, uint256 index) public view virtual override returns (uint256) { return _holderTokens[owner].at(index); } /** * @dev See {IERC721Enumerable-totalSupply}. */ function totalSupply() public view virtual override returns (uint256) { // _tokenOwners are indexed by tokenIds, so .length() returns the number of tokenIds return _tokenOwners.length(); } /** * @dev See {IERC721Enumerable-tokenByIndex}. */ function tokenByIndex(uint256 index) public view virtual override returns (uint256) { (uint256 tokenId, ) = _tokenOwners.at(index); return tokenId; } /** * @dev See {IERC721-approve}. */ function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) public virtual override { address owner = ERC721.ownerOf(tokenId); require(to != owner, "ERC721: approval to current owner"); require(_msgSender() == owner || ERC721.isApprovedForAll(owner, _msgSender()), "ERC721: approve caller is not owner nor approved for all" ); _approve(to, tokenId); } /** * @dev See {IERC721-getApproved}. */ function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) { require(_exists(tokenId), "ERC721: approved query for nonexistent token"); return _tokenApprovals[tokenId]; } /** * @dev See {IERC721-setApprovalForAll}. */ function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool approved) public virtual override { require(operator != _msgSender(), "ERC721: approve to caller"); _operatorApprovals[_msgSender()][operator] = approved; emit ApprovalForAll(_msgSender(), operator, approved); } /** * @dev See {IERC721-isApprovedForAll}. */ function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) public view virtual override returns (bool) { return _operatorApprovals[owner][operator]; } /** * @dev See {IERC721-transferFrom}. */ function transferFrom(address from, address to, uint256 tokenId) public virtual override { //solhint-disable-next-line max-line-length require(_isApprovedOrOwner(_msgSender(), tokenId), "ERC721: transfer caller is not owner nor approved"); _transfer(from, to, tokenId); } /** * @dev See {IERC721-safeTransferFrom}. */ function safeTransferFrom(address from, address to, uint256 tokenId) public virtual override { safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, ""); } /** * @dev See {IERC721-safeTransferFrom}. */ function safeTransferFrom(address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes memory _data) public virtual override { require(_isApprovedOrOwner(_msgSender(), tokenId), "ERC721: transfer caller is not owner nor approved"); _safeTransfer(from, to, tokenId, _data); } /** * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`, checking first that contract recipients * are aware of the ERC721 protocol to prevent tokens from being forever locked. * * `_data` is additional data, it has no specified format and it is sent in call to `to`. * * This internal function is equivalent to {safeTransferFrom}, and can be used to e.g. * implement alternative mechanisms to perform token transfer, such as signature-based. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`. * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function _safeTransfer(address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes memory _data) internal virtual { _transfer(from, to, tokenId); require(_checkOnERC721Received(from, to, tokenId, _data), "ERC721: transfer to non ERC721Receiver implementer"); } /** * @dev Returns whether `tokenId` exists. * * Tokens can be managed by their owner or approved accounts via {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * * Tokens start existing when they are minted (`_mint`), * and stop existing when they are burned (`_burn`). */ function _exists(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (bool) { return _tokenOwners.contains(tokenId); } /** * @dev Returns whether `spender` is allowed to manage `tokenId`. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. */ function _isApprovedOrOwner(address spender, uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (bool) { require(_exists(tokenId), "ERC721: operator query for nonexistent token"); address owner = ERC721.ownerOf(tokenId); return (spender == owner || getApproved(tokenId) == spender || ERC721.isApprovedForAll(owner, spender)); } /** * @dev Safely mints `tokenId` and transfers it to `to`. * * Requirements: d* * - `tokenId` must not exist. * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function _safeMint(address to, uint256 tokenId) internal virtual { _safeMint(to, tokenId, ""); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-ERC721-_safeMint-address-uint256-}[`_safeMint`], with an additional `data` parameter which is * forwarded in {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received} to contract recipients. */ function _safeMint(address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes memory _data) internal virtual { _mint(to, tokenId); require(_checkOnERC721Received(address(0), to, tokenId, _data), "ERC721: transfer to non ERC721Receiver implementer"); } /** * @dev Mints `tokenId` and transfers it to `to`. * * WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {_safeMint} whenever possible * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must not exist. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function _mint(address to, uint256 tokenId) internal virtual { require(to != address(0), "ERC721: mint to the zero address"); require(!_exists(tokenId), "ERC721: token already minted"); _beforeTokenTransfer(address(0), to, tokenId); _holderTokens[to].add(tokenId); _tokenOwners.set(tokenId, to); emit Transfer(address(0), to, tokenId); } /** * @dev Destroys `tokenId`. * The approval is cleared when the token is burned. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function _burn(uint256 tokenId) internal virtual { address owner = ERC721.ownerOf(tokenId); // internal owner _beforeTokenTransfer(owner, address(0), tokenId); // Clear approvals _approve(address(0), tokenId); // Clear metadata (if any) if (bytes(_tokenURIs[tokenId]).length != 0) { delete _tokenURIs[tokenId]; } _holderTokens[owner].remove(tokenId); _tokenOwners.remove(tokenId); emit Transfer(owner, address(0), tokenId); } /** * @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`. * As opposed to {transferFrom}, this imposes no restrictions on msg.sender. * * Requirements: * * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function _transfer(address from, address to, uint256 tokenId) internal virtual { require(ERC721.ownerOf(tokenId) == from, "ERC721: transfer of token that is not own"); // internal owner require(to != address(0), "ERC721: transfer to the zero address"); _beforeTokenTransfer(from, to, tokenId); // Clear approvals from the previous owner _approve(address(0), tokenId); _holderTokens[from].remove(tokenId); _holderTokens[to].add(tokenId); _tokenOwners.set(tokenId, to); emit Transfer(from, to, tokenId); } /** * @dev Sets `_tokenURI` as the tokenURI of `tokenId`. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. */ function _setTokenURI(uint256 tokenId, string memory _tokenURI) internal virtual { require(_exists(tokenId), "ERC721Metadata: URI set of nonexistent token"); _tokenURIs[tokenId] = _tokenURI; } /** * @dev Internal function to set the base URI for all token IDs. It is * automatically added as a prefix to the value returned in {tokenURI}, * or to the token ID if {tokenURI} is empty. */ function _setBaseURI(string memory baseURI_) internal virtual { _baseURI = baseURI_; } /** * @dev Internal function to invoke {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received} on a target address. * The call is not executed if the target address is not a contract. * * @param from address representing the previous owner of the given token ID * @param to target address that will receive the tokens * @param tokenId uint256 ID of the token to be transferred * @param _data bytes optional data to send along with the call * @return bool whether the call correctly returned the expected magic value */ function _checkOnERC721Received(address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes memory _data) private returns (bool) { if (!to.isContract()) { return true; } bytes memory returndata = to.functionCall(abi.encodeWithSelector( IERC721Receiver(to).onERC721Received.selector, _msgSender(), from, tokenId, _data ), "ERC721: transfer to non ERC721Receiver implementer"); bytes4 retval = abi.decode(returndata, (bytes4)); return (retval == _ERC721_RECEIVED); } /** * @dev Approve `to` to operate on `tokenId` * * Emits an {Approval} event. */ function _approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) internal virtual { _tokenApprovals[tokenId] = to; emit Approval(ERC721.ownerOf(tokenId), to, tokenId); // internal owner } /** * @dev Hook that is called before any token transfer. This includes minting * and burning. * * Calling conditions: * * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, ``from``'s `tokenId` will be * transferred to `to`. * - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`. * - When `to` is zero, ``from``'s `tokenId` will be burned. * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * * To learn more about hooks, head to xref:ROOT:extending-contracts.adoc#using-hooks[Using Hooks]. */ function _beforeTokenTransfer(address from, address to, uint256 tokenId) internal virtual { } } // File: @openzeppelin/contracts/access/Ownable.sol pragma solidity >=0.6.0 <0.8.0; /** * @dev Contract module which provides a basic access control mechanism, where * there is an account (an owner) that can be granted exclusive access to * specific functions. * * By default, the owner account will be the one that deploys the contract. This * can later be changed with {transferOwnership}. * * This module is used through inheritance. It will make available the modifier * `onlyOwner`, which can be applied to your functions to restrict their use to * the owner. */ abstract contract Ownable is Context { address private _owner; event OwnershipTransferred(address indexed previousOwner, address indexed newOwner); /** * @dev Initializes the contract setting the deployer as the initial owner. */ constructor () internal { address msgSender = _msgSender(); _owner = msgSender; emit OwnershipTransferred(address(0), msgSender); } /** * @dev Returns the address of the current owner. */ function owner() public view virtual returns (address) { return _owner; } /** * @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner. */ modifier onlyOwner() { require(owner() == _msgSender(), "Ownable: caller is not the owner"); _; } /** * @dev Leaves the contract without owner. It will not be possible to call * `onlyOwner` functions anymore. Can only be called by the current owner. * * NOTE: Renouncing ownership will leave the contract without an owner, * thereby removing any functionality that is only available to the owner. */ function renounceOwnership() public virtual onlyOwner { emit OwnershipTransferred(_owner, address(0)); _owner = address(0); } /** * @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`). * Can only be called by the current owner. */ function transferOwnership(address newOwner) public virtual onlyOwner { require(newOwner != address(0), "Ownable: new owner is the zero address"); emit OwnershipTransferred(_owner, newOwner); _owner = newOwner; } } // File: contracts/StandardMilady.sol pragma solidity 0.7.0; /** * @title Miladys contract * @dev Extends ERC721 Non-Fungible Token Standard basic implementation */ contract Miladys is ERC721, Ownable { using SafeMath for uint256; string public MILADY_PROVENANCE = ""; uint public constant maxMiladyPurchase = 30; uint256 public constant MAX_MILADYS = 9500; bool public saleIsActive = false; uint256 public standardMiladyCount = 0; mapping(address => bool) public whitelistOneMint; mapping(address => bool) public whitelistTwoMint; constructor() ERC721("Milady", "MIL") { } function setProvenanceHash(string memory provenanceHash) public onlyOwner { MILADY_PROVENANCE = provenanceHash; } function withdraw() public onlyOwner { uint balance = address(this).balance; msg.sender.transfer(balance); } function editWhitelistOne(address[] memory array) public onlyOwner { for(uint256 i = 0; i < array.length; i++) { address addressElement = array[i]; whitelistOneMint[addressElement] = true; } } function editWhitelistTwo(address[] memory array) public onlyOwner { for(uint256 i = 0; i < array.length; i++) { address addressElement = array[i]; whitelistTwoMint[addressElement] = true; } } function reserveMintMiladys() public { require(whitelistTwoMint[msg.sender] || whitelistOneMint[msg.sender], "sender not whitelisted"); uint mintAmount; if (whitelistTwoMint[msg.sender]) { whitelistTwoMint[msg.sender] = false; mintAmount = 2; } else { whitelistOneMint[msg.sender] = false; mintAmount = 1; } uint i; for (i = 0; i < mintAmount && totalSupply() < 10000; i++) { uint supply = totalSupply(); _safeMint(msg.sender, supply); } } function flipSaleState() public onlyOwner { saleIsActive = !saleIsActive; } function setBaseURI(string memory baseURI) public onlyOwner { _setBaseURI(baseURI); } function mintMiladys(uint256 numberOfTokens) public payable { require(saleIsActive, "Sale must be active to mint Miladys"); require(numberOfTokens <= maxMiladyPurchase, "Can only mint up to 30 tokens at a time"); require(standardMiladyCount.add(numberOfTokens) <= MAX_MILADYS, "Purchase would exceed max supply of Miladys"); uint256 miladyPrice; if (numberOfTokens == 30) { miladyPrice = 60000000000000000; // 0.06 ETH require(miladyPrice.mul(numberOfTokens) <= msg.value, "Ether value sent is not correct"); } else if (numberOfTokens >= 15) { miladyPrice = 70000000000000000; // 0.07 ETH require(miladyPrice.mul(numberOfTokens) <= msg.value, "Ether value sent is not correct"); } else if (numberOfTokens >= 5) { miladyPrice = 75000000000000000; // 0.075 ETH require(miladyPrice.mul(numberOfTokens) <= msg.value, "Ether value sent is not correct"); } else { miladyPrice = 80000000000000000; // 0.08 ETH require(miladyPrice.mul(numberOfTokens) <= msg.value, "Ether value sent is not correct"); } for(uint i = 0; i < numberOfTokens; i++) { if (standardMiladyCount < MAX_MILADYS) { _safeMint(msg.sender, totalSupply()); standardMiladyCount++; } } } }
File 3 of 5: SSRWives
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // File @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/[email protected] // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Context.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.0; /** * @dev Provides information about the current execution context, including the * sender of the transaction and its data. While these are generally available * via msg.sender and msg.data, they should not be accessed in such a direct * manner, since when dealing with meta-transactions the account sending and * paying for execution may not be the actual sender (as far as an application * is concerned). * * This contract is only required for intermediate, library-like contracts. */ abstract contract Context { function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address) { return msg.sender; } function _msgData() internal view virtual returns (bytes calldata) { return msg.data; } } // File @openzeppelin/contracts/access/[email protected] // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (access/Ownable.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.0; /** * @dev Contract module which provides a basic access control mechanism, where * there is an account (an owner) that can be granted exclusive access to * specific functions. * * By default, the owner account will be the one that deploys the contract. This * can later be changed with {transferOwnership}. * * This module is used through inheritance. It will make available the modifier * `onlyOwner`, which can be applied to your functions to restrict their use to * the owner. */ abstract contract Ownable is Context { address private _owner; event OwnershipTransferred(address indexed previousOwner, address indexed newOwner); /** * @dev Initializes the contract setting the deployer as the initial owner. */ constructor() { _transferOwnership(_msgSender()); } /** * @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner. */ modifier onlyOwner() { _checkOwner(); _; } /** * @dev Returns the address of the current owner. */ function owner() public view virtual returns (address) { return _owner; } /** * @dev Throws if the sender is not the owner. */ function _checkOwner() internal view virtual { require(owner() == _msgSender(), "Ownable: caller is not the owner"); } /** * @dev Leaves the contract without owner. It will not be possible to call * `onlyOwner` functions anymore. Can only be called by the current owner. * * NOTE: Renouncing ownership will leave the contract without an owner, * thereby removing any functionality that is only available to the owner. */ function renounceOwnership() public virtual onlyOwner { _transferOwnership(address(0)); } /** * @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`). * Can only be called by the current owner. */ function transferOwnership(address newOwner) public virtual onlyOwner { require(newOwner != address(0), "Ownable: new owner is the zero address"); _transferOwnership(newOwner); } /** * @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`). * Internal function without access restriction. */ function _transferOwnership(address newOwner) internal virtual { address oldOwner = _owner; _owner = newOwner; emit OwnershipTransferred(oldOwner, newOwner); } } // File @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/introspection/[email protected] // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/IERC165.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.0; /** * @dev Interface of the ERC165 standard, as defined in the * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165[EIP]. * * Implementers can declare support of contract interfaces, which can then be * queried by others ({ERC165Checker}). * * For an implementation, see {ERC165}. */ interface IERC165 { /** * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified[EIP section] * to learn more about how these ids are created. * * This function call must use less than 30 000 gas. */ function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool); } // File @openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/[email protected] // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (token/ERC721/IERC721.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.0; /** * @dev Required interface of an ERC721 compliant contract. */ interface IERC721 is IERC165 { /** * @dev Emitted when `tokenId` token is transferred from `from` to `to`. */ event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 indexed tokenId); /** * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables `approved` to manage the `tokenId` token. */ event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed approved, uint256 indexed tokenId); /** * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables or disables (`approved`) `operator` to manage all of its assets. */ event ApprovalForAll(address indexed owner, address indexed operator, bool approved); /** * @dev Returns the number of tokens in ``owner``'s account. */ function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256 balance); /** * @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. */ function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address owner); /** * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`. * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function safeTransferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes calldata data ) external; /** * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`, checking first that contract recipients * are aware of the ERC721 protocol to prevent tokens from being forever locked. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`. * - If the caller is not `from`, it must have been allowed to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function safeTransferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) external; /** * @dev Transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`. * * WARNING: Note that the caller is responsible to confirm that the recipient is capable of receiving ERC721 * or else they may be permanently lost. Usage of {safeTransferFrom} prevents loss, though the caller must * understand this adds an external call which potentially creates a reentrancy vulnerability. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`. * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) external; /** * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account. * The approval is cleared when the token is transferred. * * Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the zero address clears previous approvals. * * Requirements: * * - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator. * - `tokenId` must exist. * * Emits an {Approval} event. */ function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) external; /** * @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller. * Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom} for any token owned by the caller. * * Requirements: * * - The `operator` cannot be the caller. * * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event. */ function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool _approved) external; /** * @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. */ function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address operator); /** * @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`. * * See {setApprovalForAll} */ function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) external view returns (bool); } // File @openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/extensions/[email protected] // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (token/ERC721/extensions/IERC721Metadata.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.0; /** * @title ERC-721 Non-Fungible Token Standard, optional metadata extension * @dev See https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-721 */ interface IERC721Metadata is IERC721 { /** * @dev Returns the token collection name. */ function name() external view returns (string memory); /** * @dev Returns the token collection symbol. */ function symbol() external view returns (string memory); /** * @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token. */ function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (string memory); } // File @openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/[email protected] // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.6.0) (token/ERC721/IERC721Receiver.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.0; /** * @title ERC721 token receiver interface * @dev Interface for any contract that wants to support safeTransfers * from ERC721 asset contracts. */ interface IERC721Receiver { /** * @dev Whenever an {IERC721} `tokenId` token is transferred to this contract via {IERC721-safeTransferFrom} * by `operator` from `from`, this function is called. * * It must return its Solidity selector to confirm the token transfer. * If any other value is returned or the interface is not implemented by the recipient, the transfer will be reverted. * * The selector can be obtained in Solidity with `IERC721Receiver.onERC721Received.selector`. */ function onERC721Received( address operator, address from, uint256 tokenId, bytes calldata data ) external returns (bytes4); } // File @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/[email protected] // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (utils/Address.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.1; /** * @dev Collection of functions related to the address type */ library Address { /** * @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract. * * [IMPORTANT] * ==== * It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns * false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract. * * Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following * types of addresses: * * - an externally-owned account * - a contract in construction * - an address where a contract will be created * - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed * ==== * * [IMPORTANT] * ==== * You shouldn't rely on `isContract` to protect against flash loan attacks! * * Preventing calls from contracts is highly discouraged. It breaks composability, breaks support for smart wallets * like Gnosis Safe, and does not provide security since it can be circumvented by calling from a contract * constructor. * ==== */ function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) { // This method relies on extcodesize/address.code.length, which returns 0 // for contracts in construction, since the code is only stored at the end // of the constructor execution. return account.code.length > 0; } /** * @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to * `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors. * * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost * of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit * imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via * `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation. * * https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more]. * * IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be * taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using * {ReentrancyGuard} or the * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern]. */ function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal { require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance"); (bool success, ) = recipient.call{value: amount}(""); require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted"); } /** * @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A * plain `call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this * function instead. * * If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this * function (like regular Solidity function calls). * * Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value, * use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`]. * * Requirements: * * - `target` must be a contract. * - calling `target` with `data` must not revert. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) { return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, "Address: low-level call failed"); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with * `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCall( address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage ) internal returns (bytes memory) { return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], * but also transferring `value` wei to `target`. * * Requirements: * * - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`. * - the called Solidity function must be `payable`. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCallWithValue( address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value ) internal returns (bytes memory) { return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed"); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but * with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCallWithValue( address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value, string memory errorMessage ) internal returns (bytes memory) { require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call"); (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{value: value}(data); return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], * but performing a static call. * * _Available since v3.3._ */ function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) { return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed"); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`], * but performing a static call. * * _Available since v3.3._ */ function functionStaticCall( address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage ) internal view returns (bytes memory) { (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data); return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], * but performing a delegate call. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) { return functionDelegateCall(target, data, "Address: low-level delegate call failed"); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`], * but performing a delegate call. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ function functionDelegateCall( address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage ) internal returns (bytes memory) { (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.delegatecall(data); return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage); } /** * @dev Tool to verify that a low level call to smart-contract was successful, and revert (either by bubbling * the revert reason or using the provided one) in case of unsuccessful call or if target was not a contract. * * _Available since v4.8._ */ function verifyCallResultFromTarget( address target, bool success, bytes memory returndata, string memory errorMessage ) internal view returns (bytes memory) { if (success) { if (returndata.length == 0) { // only check isContract if the call was successful and the return data is empty // otherwise we already know that it was a contract require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract"); } return returndata; } else { _revert(returndata, errorMessage); } } /** * @dev Tool to verify that a low level call was successful, and revert if it wasn't, either by bubbling the * revert reason or using the provided one. * * _Available since v4.3._ */ function verifyCallResult( bool success, bytes memory returndata, string memory errorMessage ) internal pure returns (bytes memory) { if (success) { return returndata; } else { _revert(returndata, errorMessage); } } function _revert(bytes memory returndata, string memory errorMessage) private pure { // Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present if (returndata.length > 0) { // The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly assembly { let returndata_size := mload(returndata) revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size) } } else { revert(errorMessage); } } } // File @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/introspection/[email protected] // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/ERC165.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.0; /** * @dev Implementation of the {IERC165} interface. * * Contracts that want to implement ERC165 should inherit from this contract and override {supportsInterface} to check * for the additional interface id that will be supported. For example: * * ```solidity * function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) { * return interfaceId == type(MyInterface).interfaceId || super.supportsInterface(interfaceId); * } * ``` * * Alternatively, {ERC165Storage} provides an easier to use but more expensive implementation. */ abstract contract ERC165 is IERC165 { /** * @dev See {IERC165-supportsInterface}. */ function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) { return interfaceId == type(IERC165).interfaceId; } } // File @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/math/[email protected] // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (utils/math/Math.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.0; /** * @dev Standard math utilities missing in the Solidity language. */ library Math { enum Rounding { Down, // Toward negative infinity Up, // Toward infinity Zero // Toward zero } /** * @dev Returns the largest of two numbers. */ function max(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { return a > b ? a : b; } /** * @dev Returns the smallest of two numbers. */ function min(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { return a < b ? a : b; } /** * @dev Returns the average of two numbers. The result is rounded towards * zero. */ function average(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { // (a + b) / 2 can overflow. return (a & b) + (a ^ b) / 2; } /** * @dev Returns the ceiling of the division of two numbers. * * This differs from standard division with `/` in that it rounds up instead * of rounding down. */ function ceilDiv(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { // (a + b - 1) / b can overflow on addition, so we distribute. return a == 0 ? 0 : (a - 1) / b + 1; } /** * @notice Calculates floor(x * y / denominator) with full precision. Throws if result overflows a uint256 or denominator == 0 * @dev Original credit to Remco Bloemen under MIT license (https://xn--2-umb.com/21/muldiv) * with further edits by Uniswap Labs also under MIT license. */ function mulDiv( uint256 x, uint256 y, uint256 denominator ) internal pure returns (uint256 result) { unchecked { // 512-bit multiply [prod1 prod0] = x * y. Compute the product mod 2^256 and mod 2^256 - 1, then use // use the Chinese Remainder Theorem to reconstruct the 512 bit result. The result is stored in two 256 // variables such that product = prod1 * 2^256 + prod0. uint256 prod0; // Least significant 256 bits of the product uint256 prod1; // Most significant 256 bits of the product assembly { let mm := mulmod(x, y, not(0)) prod0 := mul(x, y) prod1 := sub(sub(mm, prod0), lt(mm, prod0)) } // Handle non-overflow cases, 256 by 256 division. if (prod1 == 0) { return prod0 / denominator; } // Make sure the result is less than 2^256. Also prevents denominator == 0. require(denominator > prod1); /////////////////////////////////////////////// // 512 by 256 division. /////////////////////////////////////////////// // Make division exact by subtracting the remainder from [prod1 prod0]. uint256 remainder; assembly { // Compute remainder using mulmod. remainder := mulmod(x, y, denominator) // Subtract 256 bit number from 512 bit number. prod1 := sub(prod1, gt(remainder, prod0)) prod0 := sub(prod0, remainder) } // Factor powers of two out of denominator and compute largest power of two divisor of denominator. Always >= 1. // See https://cs.stackexchange.com/q/138556/92363. // Does not overflow because the denominator cannot be zero at this stage in the function. uint256 twos = denominator & (~denominator + 1); assembly { // Divide denominator by twos. denominator := div(denominator, twos) // Divide [prod1 prod0] by twos. prod0 := div(prod0, twos) // Flip twos such that it is 2^256 / twos. If twos is zero, then it becomes one. twos := add(div(sub(0, twos), twos), 1) } // Shift in bits from prod1 into prod0. prod0 |= prod1 * twos; // Invert denominator mod 2^256. Now that denominator is an odd number, it has an inverse modulo 2^256 such // that denominator * inv = 1 mod 2^256. Compute the inverse by starting with a seed that is correct for // four bits. That is, denominator * inv = 1 mod 2^4. uint256 inverse = (3 * denominator) ^ 2; // Use the Newton-Raphson iteration to improve the precision. Thanks to Hensel's lifting lemma, this also works // in modular arithmetic, doubling the correct bits in each step. inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^8 inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^16 inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^32 inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^64 inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^128 inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^256 // Because the division is now exact we can divide by multiplying with the modular inverse of denominator. // This will give us the correct result modulo 2^256. Since the preconditions guarantee that the outcome is // less than 2^256, this is the final result. We don't need to compute the high bits of the result and prod1 // is no longer required. result = prod0 * inverse; return result; } } /** * @notice Calculates x * y / denominator with full precision, following the selected rounding direction. */ function mulDiv( uint256 x, uint256 y, uint256 denominator, Rounding rounding ) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 result = mulDiv(x, y, denominator); if (rounding == Rounding.Up && mulmod(x, y, denominator) > 0) { result += 1; } return result; } /** * @dev Returns the square root of a number. If the number is not a perfect square, the value is rounded down. * * Inspired by Henry S. Warren, Jr.'s "Hacker's Delight" (Chapter 11). */ function sqrt(uint256 a) internal pure returns (uint256) { if (a == 0) { return 0; } // For our first guess, we get the biggest power of 2 which is smaller than the square root of the target. // // We know that the "msb" (most significant bit) of our target number `a` is a power of 2 such that we have // `msb(a) <= a < 2*msb(a)`. This value can be written `msb(a)=2**k` with `k=log2(a)`. // // This can be rewritten `2**log2(a) <= a < 2**(log2(a) + 1)` // → `sqrt(2**k) <= sqrt(a) < sqrt(2**(k+1))` // → `2**(k/2) <= sqrt(a) < 2**((k+1)/2) <= 2**(k/2 + 1)` // // Consequently, `2**(log2(a) / 2)` is a good first approximation of `sqrt(a)` with at least 1 correct bit. uint256 result = 1 << (log2(a) >> 1); // At this point `result` is an estimation with one bit of precision. We know the true value is a uint128, // since it is the square root of a uint256. Newton's method converges quadratically (precision doubles at // every iteration). We thus need at most 7 iteration to turn our partial result with one bit of precision // into the expected uint128 result. unchecked { result = (result + a / result) >> 1; result = (result + a / result) >> 1; result = (result + a / result) >> 1; result = (result + a / result) >> 1; result = (result + a / result) >> 1; result = (result + a / result) >> 1; result = (result + a / result) >> 1; return min(result, a / result); } } /** * @notice Calculates sqrt(a), following the selected rounding direction. */ function sqrt(uint256 a, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) { unchecked { uint256 result = sqrt(a); return result + (rounding == Rounding.Up && result * result < a ? 1 : 0); } } /** * @dev Return the log in base 2, rounded down, of a positive value. * Returns 0 if given 0. */ function log2(uint256 value) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 result = 0; unchecked { if (value >> 128 > 0) { value >>= 128; result += 128; } if (value >> 64 > 0) { value >>= 64; result += 64; } if (value >> 32 > 0) { value >>= 32; result += 32; } if (value >> 16 > 0) { value >>= 16; result += 16; } if (value >> 8 > 0) { value >>= 8; result += 8; } if (value >> 4 > 0) { value >>= 4; result += 4; } if (value >> 2 > 0) { value >>= 2; result += 2; } if (value >> 1 > 0) { result += 1; } } return result; } /** * @dev Return the log in base 2, following the selected rounding direction, of a positive value. * Returns 0 if given 0. */ function log2(uint256 value, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) { unchecked { uint256 result = log2(value); return result + (rounding == Rounding.Up && 1 << result < value ? 1 : 0); } } /** * @dev Return the log in base 10, rounded down, of a positive value. * Returns 0 if given 0. */ function log10(uint256 value) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 result = 0; unchecked { if (value >= 10**64) { value /= 10**64; result += 64; } if (value >= 10**32) { value /= 10**32; result += 32; } if (value >= 10**16) { value /= 10**16; result += 16; } if (value >= 10**8) { value /= 10**8; result += 8; } if (value >= 10**4) { value /= 10**4; result += 4; } if (value >= 10**2) { value /= 10**2; result += 2; } if (value >= 10**1) { result += 1; } } return result; } /** * @dev Return the log in base 10, following the selected rounding direction, of a positive value. * Returns 0 if given 0. */ function log10(uint256 value, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) { unchecked { uint256 result = log10(value); return result + (rounding == Rounding.Up && 10**result < value ? 1 : 0); } } /** * @dev Return the log in base 256, rounded down, of a positive value. * Returns 0 if given 0. * * Adding one to the result gives the number of pairs of hex symbols needed to represent `value` as a hex string. */ function log256(uint256 value) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 result = 0; unchecked { if (value >> 128 > 0) { value >>= 128; result += 16; } if (value >> 64 > 0) { value >>= 64; result += 8; } if (value >> 32 > 0) { value >>= 32; result += 4; } if (value >> 16 > 0) { value >>= 16; result += 2; } if (value >> 8 > 0) { result += 1; } } return result; } /** * @dev Return the log in base 10, following the selected rounding direction, of a positive value. * Returns 0 if given 0. */ function log256(uint256 value, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) { unchecked { uint256 result = log256(value); return result + (rounding == Rounding.Up && 1 << (result * 8) < value ? 1 : 0); } } } // File @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/[email protected] // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (utils/Strings.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.0; /** * @dev String operations. */ library Strings { bytes16 private constant _SYMBOLS = "0123456789abcdef"; uint8 private constant _ADDRESS_LENGTH = 20; /** * @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` decimal representation. */ function toString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) { unchecked { uint256 length = Math.log10(value) + 1; string memory buffer = new string(length); uint256 ptr; /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly assembly { ptr := add(buffer, add(32, length)) } while (true) { ptr--; /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly assembly { mstore8(ptr, byte(mod(value, 10), _SYMBOLS)) } value /= 10; if (value == 0) break; } return buffer; } } /** * @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation. */ function toHexString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) { unchecked { return toHexString(value, Math.log256(value) + 1); } } /** * @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation with fixed length. */ function toHexString(uint256 value, uint256 length) internal pure returns (string memory) { bytes memory buffer = new bytes(2 * length + 2); buffer[0] = "0"; buffer[1] = "x"; for (uint256 i = 2 * length + 1; i > 1; --i) { buffer[i] = _SYMBOLS[value & 0xf]; value >>= 4; } require(value == 0, "Strings: hex length insufficient"); return string(buffer); } /** * @dev Converts an `address` with fixed length of 20 bytes to its not checksummed ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation. */ function toHexString(address addr) internal pure returns (string memory) { return toHexString(uint256(uint160(addr)), _ADDRESS_LENGTH); } } // File @openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/[email protected] // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (token/ERC721/ERC721.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.0; /** * @dev Implementation of https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-721[ERC721] Non-Fungible Token Standard, including * the Metadata extension, but not including the Enumerable extension, which is available separately as * {ERC721Enumerable}. */ contract ERC721 is Context, ERC165, IERC721, IERC721Metadata { using Address for address; using Strings for uint256; // Token name string private _name; // Token symbol string private _symbol; // Mapping from token ID to owner address mapping(uint256 => address) private _owners; // Mapping owner address to token count mapping(address => uint256) private _balances; // Mapping from token ID to approved address mapping(uint256 => address) private _tokenApprovals; // Mapping from owner to operator approvals mapping(address => mapping(address => bool)) private _operatorApprovals; /** * @dev Initializes the contract by setting a `name` and a `symbol` to the token collection. */ constructor(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) { _name = name_; _symbol = symbol_; } /** * @dev See {IERC165-supportsInterface}. */ function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override(ERC165, IERC165) returns (bool) { return interfaceId == type(IERC721).interfaceId || interfaceId == type(IERC721Metadata).interfaceId || super.supportsInterface(interfaceId); } /** * @dev See {IERC721-balanceOf}. */ function balanceOf(address owner) public view virtual override returns (uint256) { require(owner != address(0), "ERC721: address zero is not a valid owner"); return _balances[owner]; } /** * @dev See {IERC721-ownerOf}. */ function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) { address owner = _ownerOf(tokenId); require(owner != address(0), "ERC721: invalid token ID"); return owner; } /** * @dev See {IERC721Metadata-name}. */ function name() public view virtual override returns (string memory) { return _name; } /** * @dev See {IERC721Metadata-symbol}. */ function symbol() public view virtual override returns (string memory) { return _symbol; } /** * @dev See {IERC721Metadata-tokenURI}. */ function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (string memory) { _requireMinted(tokenId); string memory baseURI = _baseURI(); return bytes(baseURI).length > 0 ? string(abi.encodePacked(baseURI, tokenId.toString())) : ""; } /** * @dev Base URI for computing {tokenURI}. If set, the resulting URI for each * token will be the concatenation of the `baseURI` and the `tokenId`. Empty * by default, can be overridden in child contracts. */ function _baseURI() internal view virtual returns (string memory) { return ""; } /** * @dev See {IERC721-approve}. */ function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) public virtual override { address owner = ERC721.ownerOf(tokenId); require(to != owner, "ERC721: approval to current owner"); require( _msgSender() == owner || isApprovedForAll(owner, _msgSender()), "ERC721: approve caller is not token owner or approved for all" ); _approve(to, tokenId); } /** * @dev See {IERC721-getApproved}. */ function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) { _requireMinted(tokenId); return _tokenApprovals[tokenId]; } /** * @dev See {IERC721-setApprovalForAll}. */ function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool approved) public virtual override { _setApprovalForAll(_msgSender(), operator, approved); } /** * @dev See {IERC721-isApprovedForAll}. */ function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) public view virtual override returns (bool) { return _operatorApprovals[owner][operator]; } /** * @dev See {IERC721-transferFrom}. */ function transferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) public virtual override { //solhint-disable-next-line max-line-length require(_isApprovedOrOwner(_msgSender(), tokenId), "ERC721: caller is not token owner or approved"); _transfer(from, to, tokenId); } /** * @dev See {IERC721-safeTransferFrom}. */ function safeTransferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) public virtual override { safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, ""); } /** * @dev See {IERC721-safeTransferFrom}. */ function safeTransferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes memory data ) public virtual override { require(_isApprovedOrOwner(_msgSender(), tokenId), "ERC721: caller is not token owner or approved"); _safeTransfer(from, to, tokenId, data); } /** * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`, checking first that contract recipients * are aware of the ERC721 protocol to prevent tokens from being forever locked. * * `data` is additional data, it has no specified format and it is sent in call to `to`. * * This internal function is equivalent to {safeTransferFrom}, and can be used to e.g. * implement alternative mechanisms to perform token transfer, such as signature-based. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`. * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function _safeTransfer( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes memory data ) internal virtual { _transfer(from, to, tokenId); require(_checkOnERC721Received(from, to, tokenId, data), "ERC721: transfer to non ERC721Receiver implementer"); } /** * @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId`. Does NOT revert if token doesn't exist */ function _ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (address) { return _owners[tokenId]; } /** * @dev Returns whether `tokenId` exists. * * Tokens can be managed by their owner or approved accounts via {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * * Tokens start existing when they are minted (`_mint`), * and stop existing when they are burned (`_burn`). */ function _exists(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (bool) { return _ownerOf(tokenId) != address(0); } /** * @dev Returns whether `spender` is allowed to manage `tokenId`. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. */ function _isApprovedOrOwner(address spender, uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (bool) { address owner = ERC721.ownerOf(tokenId); return (spender == owner || isApprovedForAll(owner, spender) || getApproved(tokenId) == spender); } /** * @dev Safely mints `tokenId` and transfers it to `to`. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must not exist. * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function _safeMint(address to, uint256 tokenId) internal virtual { _safeMint(to, tokenId, ""); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-ERC721-_safeMint-address-uint256-}[`_safeMint`], with an additional `data` parameter which is * forwarded in {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received} to contract recipients. */ function _safeMint( address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes memory data ) internal virtual { _mint(to, tokenId); require( _checkOnERC721Received(address(0), to, tokenId, data), "ERC721: transfer to non ERC721Receiver implementer" ); } /** * @dev Mints `tokenId` and transfers it to `to`. * * WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {_safeMint} whenever possible * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must not exist. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function _mint(address to, uint256 tokenId) internal virtual { require(to != address(0), "ERC721: mint to the zero address"); require(!_exists(tokenId), "ERC721: token already minted"); _beforeTokenTransfer(address(0), to, tokenId, 1); // Check that tokenId was not minted by `_beforeTokenTransfer` hook require(!_exists(tokenId), "ERC721: token already minted"); unchecked { // Will not overflow unless all 2**256 token ids are minted to the same owner. // Given that tokens are minted one by one, it is impossible in practice that // this ever happens. Might change if we allow batch minting. // The ERC fails to describe this case. _balances[to] += 1; } _owners[tokenId] = to; emit Transfer(address(0), to, tokenId); _afterTokenTransfer(address(0), to, tokenId, 1); } /** * @dev Destroys `tokenId`. * The approval is cleared when the token is burned. * This is an internal function that does not check if the sender is authorized to operate on the token. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function _burn(uint256 tokenId) internal virtual { address owner = ERC721.ownerOf(tokenId); _beforeTokenTransfer(owner, address(0), tokenId, 1); // Update ownership in case tokenId was transferred by `_beforeTokenTransfer` hook owner = ERC721.ownerOf(tokenId); // Clear approvals delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]; unchecked { // Cannot overflow, as that would require more tokens to be burned/transferred // out than the owner initially received through minting and transferring in. _balances[owner] -= 1; } delete _owners[tokenId]; emit Transfer(owner, address(0), tokenId); _afterTokenTransfer(owner, address(0), tokenId, 1); } /** * @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`. * As opposed to {transferFrom}, this imposes no restrictions on msg.sender. * * Requirements: * * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function _transfer( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) internal virtual { require(ERC721.ownerOf(tokenId) == from, "ERC721: transfer from incorrect owner"); require(to != address(0), "ERC721: transfer to the zero address"); _beforeTokenTransfer(from, to, tokenId, 1); // Check that tokenId was not transferred by `_beforeTokenTransfer` hook require(ERC721.ownerOf(tokenId) == from, "ERC721: transfer from incorrect owner"); // Clear approvals from the previous owner delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]; unchecked { // `_balances[from]` cannot overflow for the same reason as described in `_burn`: // `from`'s balance is the number of token held, which is at least one before the current // transfer. // `_balances[to]` could overflow in the conditions described in `_mint`. That would require // all 2**256 token ids to be minted, which in practice is impossible. _balances[from] -= 1; _balances[to] += 1; } _owners[tokenId] = to; emit Transfer(from, to, tokenId); _afterTokenTransfer(from, to, tokenId, 1); } /** * @dev Approve `to` to operate on `tokenId` * * Emits an {Approval} event. */ function _approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) internal virtual { _tokenApprovals[tokenId] = to; emit Approval(ERC721.ownerOf(tokenId), to, tokenId); } /** * @dev Approve `operator` to operate on all of `owner` tokens * * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event. */ function _setApprovalForAll( address owner, address operator, bool approved ) internal virtual { require(owner != operator, "ERC721: approve to caller"); _operatorApprovals[owner][operator] = approved; emit ApprovalForAll(owner, operator, approved); } /** * @dev Reverts if the `tokenId` has not been minted yet. */ function _requireMinted(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual { require(_exists(tokenId), "ERC721: invalid token ID"); } /** * @dev Internal function to invoke {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received} on a target address. * The call is not executed if the target address is not a contract. * * @param from address representing the previous owner of the given token ID * @param to target address that will receive the tokens * @param tokenId uint256 ID of the token to be transferred * @param data bytes optional data to send along with the call * @return bool whether the call correctly returned the expected magic value */ function _checkOnERC721Received( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes memory data ) private returns (bool) { if (to.isContract()) { try IERC721Receiver(to).onERC721Received(_msgSender(), from, tokenId, data) returns (bytes4 retval) { return retval == IERC721Receiver.onERC721Received.selector; } catch (bytes memory reason) { if (reason.length == 0) { revert("ERC721: transfer to non ERC721Receiver implementer"); } else { /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly assembly { revert(add(32, reason), mload(reason)) } } } } else { return true; } } /** * @dev Hook that is called before any token transfer. This includes minting and burning. If {ERC721Consecutive} is * used, the hook may be called as part of a consecutive (batch) mint, as indicated by `batchSize` greater than 1. * * Calling conditions: * * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, ``from``'s tokens will be transferred to `to`. * - When `from` is zero, the tokens will be minted for `to`. * - When `to` is zero, ``from``'s tokens will be burned. * - `from` and `to` are never both zero. * - `batchSize` is non-zero. * * To learn more about hooks, head to xref:ROOT:extending-contracts.adoc#using-hooks[Using Hooks]. */ function _beforeTokenTransfer( address from, address to, uint256, /* firstTokenId */ uint256 batchSize ) internal virtual { if (batchSize > 1) { if (from != address(0)) { _balances[from] -= batchSize; } if (to != address(0)) { _balances[to] += batchSize; } } } /** * @dev Hook that is called after any token transfer. This includes minting and burning. If {ERC721Consecutive} is * used, the hook may be called as part of a consecutive (batch) mint, as indicated by `batchSize` greater than 1. * * Calling conditions: * * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, ``from``'s tokens were transferred to `to`. * - When `from` is zero, the tokens were minted for `to`. * - When `to` is zero, ``from``'s tokens were burned. * - `from` and `to` are never both zero. * - `batchSize` is non-zero. * * To learn more about hooks, head to xref:ROOT:extending-contracts.adoc#using-hooks[Using Hooks]. */ function _afterTokenTransfer( address from, address to, uint256 firstTokenId, uint256 batchSize ) internal virtual {} } // File erc721a/contracts/[email protected] // ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3 // Creator: Chiru Labs pragma solidity ^0.8.4; /** * @dev Interface of ERC721A. */ interface IERC721A { /** * The caller must own the token or be an approved operator. */ error ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved(); /** * The token does not exist. */ error ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken(); /** * Cannot query the balance for the zero address. */ error BalanceQueryForZeroAddress(); /** * Cannot mint to the zero address. */ error MintToZeroAddress(); /** * The quantity of tokens minted must be more than zero. */ error MintZeroQuantity(); /** * The token does not exist. */ error OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken(); /** * The caller must own the token or be an approved operator. */ error TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved(); /** * The token must be owned by `from`. */ error TransferFromIncorrectOwner(); /** * Cannot safely transfer to a contract that does not implement the * ERC721Receiver interface. */ error TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer(); /** * Cannot transfer to the zero address. */ error TransferToZeroAddress(); /** * The token does not exist. */ error URIQueryForNonexistentToken(); /** * The `quantity` minted with ERC2309 exceeds the safety limit. */ error MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit(); /** * The `extraData` cannot be set on an unintialized ownership slot. */ error OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData(); // ============================================================= // STRUCTS // ============================================================= struct TokenOwnership { // The address of the owner. address addr; // Stores the start time of ownership with minimal overhead for tokenomics. uint64 startTimestamp; // Whether the token has been burned. bool burned; // Arbitrary data similar to `startTimestamp` that can be set via {_extraData}. uint24 extraData; } // ============================================================= // TOKEN COUNTERS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence. * Burned tokens will reduce the count. * To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}. */ function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256); // ============================================================= // IERC165 // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding * [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified) * to learn more about how these ids are created. * * This function call must use less than 30000 gas. */ function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool); // ============================================================= // IERC721 // ============================================================= /** * @dev Emitted when `tokenId` token is transferred from `from` to `to`. */ event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 indexed tokenId); /** * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables `approved` to manage the `tokenId` token. */ event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed approved, uint256 indexed tokenId); /** * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables or disables * (`approved`) `operator` to manage all of its assets. */ event ApprovalForAll(address indexed owner, address indexed operator, bool approved); /** * @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account. */ function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256 balance); /** * @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. */ function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address owner); /** * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`, * checking first that contract recipients are aware of the ERC721 protocol * to prevent tokens from being forever locked. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`. * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be have been allowed to move * this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement * {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function safeTransferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes calldata data ) external payable; /** * @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`. */ function safeTransferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) external payable; /** * @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`. * * WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {safeTransferFrom} * whenever possible. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`. * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token * by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) external payable; /** * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account. * The approval is cleared when the token is transferred. * * Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the * zero address clears previous approvals. * * Requirements: * * - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator. * - `tokenId` must exist. * * Emits an {Approval} event. */ function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) external payable; /** * @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller. * Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom} * for any token owned by the caller. * * Requirements: * * - The `operator` cannot be the caller. * * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event. */ function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool _approved) external; /** * @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. */ function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address operator); /** * @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`. * * See {setApprovalForAll}. */ function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) external view returns (bool); // ============================================================= // IERC721Metadata // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the token collection name. */ function name() external view returns (string memory); /** * @dev Returns the token collection symbol. */ function symbol() external view returns (string memory); /** * @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token. */ function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (string memory); // ============================================================= // IERC2309 // ============================================================= /** * @dev Emitted when tokens in `fromTokenId` to `toTokenId` * (inclusive) is transferred from `from` to `to`, as defined in the * [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309) standard. * * See {_mintERC2309} for more details. */ event ConsecutiveTransfer(uint256 indexed fromTokenId, uint256 toTokenId, address indexed from, address indexed to); } // File erc721a/contracts/[email protected] // ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3 // Creator: Chiru Labs pragma solidity ^0.8.4; /** * @dev Interface of ERC721 token receiver. */ interface ERC721A__IERC721Receiver { function onERC721Received( address operator, address from, uint256 tokenId, bytes calldata data ) external returns (bytes4); } /** * @title ERC721A * * @dev Implementation of the [ERC721](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-721) * Non-Fungible Token Standard, including the Metadata extension. * Optimized for lower gas during batch mints. * * Token IDs are minted in sequential order (e.g. 0, 1, 2, 3, ...) * starting from `_startTokenId()`. * * Assumptions: * * - An owner cannot have more than 2**64 - 1 (max value of uint64) of supply. * - The maximum token ID cannot exceed 2**256 - 1 (max value of uint256). */ contract ERC721A is IERC721A { // Bypass for a `--via-ir` bug (https://github.com/chiru-labs/ERC721A/pull/364). struct TokenApprovalRef { address value; } // ============================================================= // CONSTANTS // ============================================================= // Mask of an entry in packed address data. uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY = (1 << 64) - 1; // The bit position of `numberMinted` in packed address data. uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED = 64; // The bit position of `numberBurned` in packed address data. uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED = 128; // The bit position of `aux` in packed address data. uint256 private constant _BITPOS_AUX = 192; // Mask of all 256 bits in packed address data except the 64 bits for `aux`. uint256 private constant _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 192) - 1; // The bit position of `startTimestamp` in packed ownership. uint256 private constant _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP = 160; // The bit mask of the `burned` bit in packed ownership. uint256 private constant _BITMASK_BURNED = 1 << 224; // The bit position of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership. uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 225; // The bit mask of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership. uint256 private constant _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 1 << 225; // The bit position of `extraData` in packed ownership. uint256 private constant _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA = 232; // Mask of all 256 bits in a packed ownership except the 24 bits for `extraData`. uint256 private constant _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 232) - 1; // The mask of the lower 160 bits for addresses. uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS = (1 << 160) - 1; // The maximum `quantity` that can be minted with {_mintERC2309}. // This limit is to prevent overflows on the address data entries. // For a limit of 5000, a total of 3.689e15 calls to {_mintERC2309} // is required to cause an overflow, which is unrealistic. uint256 private constant _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT = 5000; // The `Transfer` event signature is given by: // `keccak256(bytes("Transfer(address,address,uint256)"))`. bytes32 private constant _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE = 0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef; // ============================================================= // STORAGE // ============================================================= // The next token ID to be minted. uint256 private _currentIndex; // The number of tokens burned. uint256 private _burnCounter; // Token name string private _name; // Token symbol string private _symbol; // Mapping from token ID to ownership details // An empty struct value does not necessarily mean the token is unowned. // See {_packedOwnershipOf} implementation for details. // // Bits Layout: // - [0..159] `addr` // - [160..223] `startTimestamp` // - [224] `burned` // - [225] `nextInitialized` // - [232..255] `extraData` mapping(uint256 => uint256) private _packedOwnerships; // Mapping owner address to address data. // // Bits Layout: // - [0..63] `balance` // - [64..127] `numberMinted` // - [128..191] `numberBurned` // - [192..255] `aux` mapping(address => uint256) private _packedAddressData; // Mapping from token ID to approved address. mapping(uint256 => TokenApprovalRef) private _tokenApprovals; // Mapping from owner to operator approvals mapping(address => mapping(address => bool)) private _operatorApprovals; // ============================================================= // CONSTRUCTOR // ============================================================= constructor(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) { _name = name_; _symbol = symbol_; _currentIndex = _startTokenId(); } // ============================================================= // TOKEN COUNTING OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the starting token ID. * To change the starting token ID, please override this function. */ function _startTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) { return 0; } /** * @dev Returns the next token ID to be minted. */ function _nextTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) { return _currentIndex; } /** * @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence. * Burned tokens will reduce the count. * To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}. */ function totalSupply() public view virtual override returns (uint256) { // Counter underflow is impossible as _burnCounter cannot be incremented // more than `_currentIndex - _startTokenId()` times. unchecked { return _currentIndex - _burnCounter - _startTokenId(); } } /** * @dev Returns the total amount of tokens minted in the contract. */ function _totalMinted() internal view virtual returns (uint256) { // Counter underflow is impossible as `_currentIndex` does not decrement, // and it is initialized to `_startTokenId()`. unchecked { return _currentIndex - _startTokenId(); } } /** * @dev Returns the total number of tokens burned. */ function _totalBurned() internal view virtual returns (uint256) { return _burnCounter; } // ============================================================= // ADDRESS DATA OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account. */ function balanceOf(address owner) public view virtual override returns (uint256) { if (owner == address(0)) revert BalanceQueryForZeroAddress(); return _packedAddressData[owner] & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY; } /** * Returns the number of tokens minted by `owner`. */ function _numberMinted(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) { return (_packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY; } /** * Returns the number of tokens burned by or on behalf of `owner`. */ function _numberBurned(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) { return (_packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY; } /** * Returns the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used). */ function _getAux(address owner) internal view returns (uint64) { return uint64(_packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_AUX); } /** * Sets the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used). * If there are multiple variables, please pack them into a uint64. */ function _setAux(address owner, uint64 aux) internal virtual { uint256 packed = _packedAddressData[owner]; uint256 auxCasted; // Cast `aux` with assembly to avoid redundant masking. assembly { auxCasted := aux } packed = (packed & _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT) | (auxCasted << _BITPOS_AUX); _packedAddressData[owner] = packed; } // ============================================================= // IERC165 // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding * [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified) * to learn more about how these ids are created. * * This function call must use less than 30000 gas. */ function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) { // The interface IDs are constants representing the first 4 bytes // of the XOR of all function selectors in the interface. // See: [ERC165](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165) // (e.g. `bytes4(i.functionA.selector ^ i.functionB.selector ^ ...)`) return interfaceId == 0x01ffc9a7 || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC165. interfaceId == 0x80ac58cd || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721. interfaceId == 0x5b5e139f; // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721Metadata. } // ============================================================= // IERC721Metadata // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the token collection name. */ function name() public view virtual override returns (string memory) { return _name; } /** * @dev Returns the token collection symbol. */ function symbol() public view virtual override returns (string memory) { return _symbol; } /** * @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token. */ function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (string memory) { if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert URIQueryForNonexistentToken(); string memory baseURI = _baseURI(); return bytes(baseURI).length != 0 ? string(abi.encodePacked(baseURI, _toString(tokenId))) : ''; } /** * @dev Base URI for computing {tokenURI}. If set, the resulting URI for each * token will be the concatenation of the `baseURI` and the `tokenId`. Empty * by default, it can be overridden in child contracts. */ function _baseURI() internal view virtual returns (string memory) { return ''; } // ============================================================= // OWNERSHIPS OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. */ function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) { return address(uint160(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId))); } /** * @dev Gas spent here starts off proportional to the maximum mint batch size. * It gradually moves to O(1) as tokens get transferred around over time. */ function _ownershipOf(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) { return _unpackedOwnership(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId)); } /** * @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct at `index`. */ function _ownershipAt(uint256 index) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) { return _unpackedOwnership(_packedOwnerships[index]); } /** * @dev Initializes the ownership slot minted at `index` for efficiency purposes. */ function _initializeOwnershipAt(uint256 index) internal virtual { if (_packedOwnerships[index] == 0) { _packedOwnerships[index] = _packedOwnershipOf(index); } } /** * Returns the packed ownership data of `tokenId`. */ function _packedOwnershipOf(uint256 tokenId) private view returns (uint256) { uint256 curr = tokenId; unchecked { if (_startTokenId() <= curr) if (curr < _currentIndex) { uint256 packed = _packedOwnerships[curr]; // If not burned. if (packed & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0) { // Invariant: // There will always be an initialized ownership slot // (i.e. `ownership.addr != address(0) && ownership.burned == false`) // before an unintialized ownership slot // (i.e. `ownership.addr == address(0) && ownership.burned == false`) // Hence, `curr` will not underflow. // // We can directly compare the packed value. // If the address is zero, packed will be zero. while (packed == 0) { packed = _packedOwnerships[--curr]; } return packed; } } } revert OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken(); } /** * @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct from `packed`. */ function _unpackedOwnership(uint256 packed) private pure returns (TokenOwnership memory ownership) { ownership.addr = address(uint160(packed)); ownership.startTimestamp = uint64(packed >> _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP); ownership.burned = packed & _BITMASK_BURNED != 0; ownership.extraData = uint24(packed >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA); } /** * @dev Packs ownership data into a single uint256. */ function _packOwnershipData(address owner, uint256 flags) private view returns (uint256 result) { assembly { // Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean. owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS) // `owner | (block.timestamp << _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP) | flags`. result := or(owner, or(shl(_BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP, timestamp()), flags)) } } /** * @dev Returns the `nextInitialized` flag set if `quantity` equals 1. */ function _nextInitializedFlag(uint256 quantity) private pure returns (uint256 result) { // For branchless setting of the `nextInitialized` flag. assembly { // `(quantity == 1) << _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED`. result := shl(_BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED, eq(quantity, 1)) } } // ============================================================= // APPROVAL OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account. * The approval is cleared when the token is transferred. * * Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the * zero address clears previous approvals. * * Requirements: * * - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator. * - `tokenId` must exist. * * Emits an {Approval} event. */ function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) public payable virtual override { address owner = ownerOf(tokenId); if (_msgSenderERC721A() != owner) if (!isApprovedForAll(owner, _msgSenderERC721A())) { revert ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved(); } _tokenApprovals[tokenId].value = to; emit Approval(owner, to, tokenId); } /** * @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. */ function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) { if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken(); return _tokenApprovals[tokenId].value; } /** * @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller. * Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom} * for any token owned by the caller. * * Requirements: * * - The `operator` cannot be the caller. * * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event. */ function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool approved) public virtual override { _operatorApprovals[_msgSenderERC721A()][operator] = approved; emit ApprovalForAll(_msgSenderERC721A(), operator, approved); } /** * @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`. * * See {setApprovalForAll}. */ function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) public view virtual override returns (bool) { return _operatorApprovals[owner][operator]; } /** * @dev Returns whether `tokenId` exists. * * Tokens can be managed by their owner or approved accounts via {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * * Tokens start existing when they are minted. See {_mint}. */ function _exists(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (bool) { return _startTokenId() <= tokenId && tokenId < _currentIndex && // If within bounds, _packedOwnerships[tokenId] & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0; // and not burned. } /** * @dev Returns whether `msgSender` is equal to `approvedAddress` or `owner`. */ function _isSenderApprovedOrOwner( address approvedAddress, address owner, address msgSender ) private pure returns (bool result) { assembly { // Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean. owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS) // Mask `msgSender` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean. msgSender := and(msgSender, _BITMASK_ADDRESS) // `msgSender == owner || msgSender == approvedAddress`. result := or(eq(msgSender, owner), eq(msgSender, approvedAddress)) } } /** * @dev Returns the storage slot and value for the approved address of `tokenId`. */ function _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(uint256 tokenId) private view returns (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) { TokenApprovalRef storage tokenApproval = _tokenApprovals[tokenId]; // The following is equivalent to `approvedAddress = _tokenApprovals[tokenId].value`. assembly { approvedAddressSlot := tokenApproval.slot approvedAddress := sload(approvedAddressSlot) } } // ============================================================= // TRANSFER OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`. * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token * by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) public payable virtual override { uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId); if (address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked)) != from) revert TransferFromIncorrectOwner(); (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId); // The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition. if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A())) if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) revert TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved(); if (to == address(0)) revert TransferToZeroAddress(); _beforeTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1); // Clear approvals from the previous owner. assembly { if approvedAddress { // This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`. sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0) } } // Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for // ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow. // Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256. unchecked { // We can directly increment and decrement the balances. --_packedAddressData[from]; // Updates: `balance -= 1`. ++_packedAddressData[to]; // Updates: `balance += 1`. // Updates: // - `address` to the next owner. // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of transfering. // - `burned` to `false`. // - `nextInitialized` to `true`. _packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData( to, _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED | _nextExtraData(from, to, prevOwnershipPacked) ); // If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) . if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) { uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1; // If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero). if (_packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) { // If the next slot is within bounds. if (nextTokenId != _currentIndex) { // Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`. _packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked; } } } } emit Transfer(from, to, tokenId); _afterTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1); } /** * @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`. */ function safeTransferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) public payable virtual override { safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, ''); } /** * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`. * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token * by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement * {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function safeTransferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes memory _data ) public payable virtual override { transferFrom(from, to, tokenId); if (to.code.length != 0) if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(from, to, tokenId, _data)) { revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer(); } } /** * @dev Hook that is called before a set of serially-ordered token IDs * are about to be transferred. This includes minting. * And also called before burning one token. * * `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred. * `quantity` - the amount to be transferred. * * Calling conditions: * * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be * transferred to `to`. * - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`. * - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`. * - `from` and `to` are never both zero. */ function _beforeTokenTransfers( address from, address to, uint256 startTokenId, uint256 quantity ) internal virtual {} /** * @dev Hook that is called after a set of serially-ordered token IDs * have been transferred. This includes minting. * And also called after one token has been burned. * * `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred. * `quantity` - the amount to be transferred. * * Calling conditions: * * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` has been * transferred to `to`. * - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` has been minted for `to`. * - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` has been burned by `from`. * - `from` and `to` are never both zero. */ function _afterTokenTransfers( address from, address to, uint256 startTokenId, uint256 quantity ) internal virtual {} /** * @dev Private function to invoke {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received} on a target contract. * * `from` - Previous owner of the given token ID. * `to` - Target address that will receive the token. * `tokenId` - Token ID to be transferred. * `_data` - Optional data to send along with the call. * * Returns whether the call correctly returned the expected magic value. */ function _checkContractOnERC721Received( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes memory _data ) private returns (bool) { try ERC721A__IERC721Receiver(to).onERC721Received(_msgSenderERC721A(), from, tokenId, _data) returns ( bytes4 retval ) { return retval == ERC721A__IERC721Receiver(to).onERC721Received.selector; } catch (bytes memory reason) { if (reason.length == 0) { revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer(); } else { assembly { revert(add(32, reason), mload(reason)) } } } } // ============================================================= // MINT OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`. * * Requirements: * * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `quantity` must be greater than 0. * * Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint. */ function _mint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual { uint256 startTokenId = _currentIndex; if (quantity == 0) revert MintZeroQuantity(); _beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity); // Overflows are incredibly unrealistic. // `balance` and `numberMinted` have a maximum limit of 2**64. // `tokenId` has a maximum limit of 2**256. unchecked { // Updates: // - `balance += quantity`. // - `numberMinted += quantity`. // // We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`. _packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1); // Updates: // - `address` to the owner. // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting. // - `burned` to `false`. // - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`. _packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData( to, _nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0) ); uint256 toMasked; uint256 end = startTokenId + quantity; // Use assembly to loop and emit the `Transfer` event for gas savings. // The duplicated `log4` removes an extra check and reduces stack juggling. // The assembly, together with the surrounding Solidity code, have been // delicately arranged to nudge the compiler into producing optimized opcodes. assembly { // Mask `to` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean. toMasked := and(to, _BITMASK_ADDRESS) // Emit the `Transfer` event. log4( 0, // Start of data (0, since no data). 0, // End of data (0, since no data). _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, // Signature. 0, // `address(0)`. toMasked, // `to`. startTokenId // `tokenId`. ) // The `iszero(eq(,))` check ensures that large values of `quantity` // that overflows uint256 will make the loop run out of gas. // The compiler will optimize the `iszero` away for performance. for { let tokenId := add(startTokenId, 1) } iszero(eq(tokenId, end)) { tokenId := add(tokenId, 1) } { // Emit the `Transfer` event. Similar to above. log4(0, 0, _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, 0, toMasked, tokenId) } } if (toMasked == 0) revert MintToZeroAddress(); _currentIndex = end; } _afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity); } /** * @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`. * * This function is intended for efficient minting only during contract creation. * * It emits only one {ConsecutiveTransfer} as defined in * [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309), * instead of a sequence of {Transfer} event(s). * * Calling this function outside of contract creation WILL make your contract * non-compliant with the ERC721 standard. * For full ERC721 compliance, substituting ERC721 {Transfer} event(s) with the ERC2309 * {ConsecutiveTransfer} event is only permissible during contract creation. * * Requirements: * * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `quantity` must be greater than 0. * * Emits a {ConsecutiveTransfer} event. */ function _mintERC2309(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual { uint256 startTokenId = _currentIndex; if (to == address(0)) revert MintToZeroAddress(); if (quantity == 0) revert MintZeroQuantity(); if (quantity > _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT) revert MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit(); _beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity); // Overflows are unrealistic due to the above check for `quantity` to be below the limit. unchecked { // Updates: // - `balance += quantity`. // - `numberMinted += quantity`. // // We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`. _packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1); // Updates: // - `address` to the owner. // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting. // - `burned` to `false`. // - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`. _packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData( to, _nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0) ); emit ConsecutiveTransfer(startTokenId, startTokenId + quantity - 1, address(0), to); _currentIndex = startTokenId + quantity; } _afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity); } /** * @dev Safely mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`. * * Requirements: * * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement * {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called for each safe transfer. * - `quantity` must be greater than 0. * * See {_mint}. * * Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint. */ function _safeMint( address to, uint256 quantity, bytes memory _data ) internal virtual { _mint(to, quantity); unchecked { if (to.code.length != 0) { uint256 end = _currentIndex; uint256 index = end - quantity; do { if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(address(0), to, index++, _data)) { revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer(); } } while (index < end); // Reentrancy protection. if (_currentIndex != end) revert(); } } } /** * @dev Equivalent to `_safeMint(to, quantity, '')`. */ function _safeMint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual { _safeMint(to, quantity, ''); } // ============================================================= // BURN OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Equivalent to `_burn(tokenId, false)`. */ function _burn(uint256 tokenId) internal virtual { _burn(tokenId, false); } /** * @dev Destroys `tokenId`. * The approval is cleared when the token is burned. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function _burn(uint256 tokenId, bool approvalCheck) internal virtual { uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId); address from = address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked)); (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId); if (approvalCheck) { // The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition. if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A())) if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) revert TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved(); } _beforeTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1); // Clear approvals from the previous owner. assembly { if approvedAddress { // This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`. sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0) } } // Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for // ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow. // Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256. unchecked { // Updates: // - `balance -= 1`. // - `numberBurned += 1`. // // We can directly decrement the balance, and increment the number burned. // This is equivalent to `packed -= 1; packed += 1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED;`. _packedAddressData[from] += (1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) - 1; // Updates: // - `address` to the last owner. // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of burning. // - `burned` to `true`. // - `nextInitialized` to `true`. _packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData( from, (_BITMASK_BURNED | _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED) | _nextExtraData(from, address(0), prevOwnershipPacked) ); // If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) . if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) { uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1; // If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero). if (_packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) { // If the next slot is within bounds. if (nextTokenId != _currentIndex) { // Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`. _packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked; } } } } emit Transfer(from, address(0), tokenId); _afterTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1); // Overflow not possible, as _burnCounter cannot be exceed _currentIndex times. unchecked { _burnCounter++; } } // ============================================================= // EXTRA DATA OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Directly sets the extra data for the ownership data `index`. */ function _setExtraDataAt(uint256 index, uint24 extraData) internal virtual { uint256 packed = _packedOwnerships[index]; if (packed == 0) revert OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData(); uint256 extraDataCasted; // Cast `extraData` with assembly to avoid redundant masking. assembly { extraDataCasted := extraData } packed = (packed & _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT) | (extraDataCasted << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA); _packedOwnerships[index] = packed; } /** * @dev Called during each token transfer to set the 24bit `extraData` field. * Intended to be overridden by the cosumer contract. * * `previousExtraData` - the value of `extraData` before transfer. * * Calling conditions: * * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be * transferred to `to`. * - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`. * - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`. * - `from` and `to` are never both zero. */ function _extraData( address from, address to, uint24 previousExtraData ) internal view virtual returns (uint24) {} /** * @dev Returns the next extra data for the packed ownership data. * The returned result is shifted into position. */ function _nextExtraData( address from, address to, uint256 prevOwnershipPacked ) private view returns (uint256) { uint24 extraData = uint24(prevOwnershipPacked >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA); return uint256(_extraData(from, to, extraData)) << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA; } // ============================================================= // OTHER OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the message sender (defaults to `msg.sender`). * * If you are writing GSN compatible contracts, you need to override this function. */ function _msgSenderERC721A() internal view virtual returns (address) { return msg.sender; } /** * @dev Converts a uint256 to its ASCII string decimal representation. */ function _toString(uint256 value) internal pure virtual returns (string memory str) { assembly { // The maximum value of a uint256 contains 78 digits (1 byte per digit), but // we allocate 0xa0 bytes to keep the free memory pointer 32-byte word aligned. // We will need 1 word for the trailing zeros padding, 1 word for the length, // and 3 words for a maximum of 78 digits. Total: 5 * 0x20 = 0xa0. let m := add(mload(0x40), 0xa0) // Update the free memory pointer to allocate. mstore(0x40, m) // Assign the `str` to the end. str := sub(m, 0x20) // Zeroize the slot after the string. mstore(str, 0) // Cache the end of the memory to calculate the length later. let end := str // We write the string from rightmost digit to leftmost digit. // The following is essentially a do-while loop that also handles the zero case. // prettier-ignore for { let temp := value } 1 {} { str := sub(str, 1) // Write the character to the pointer. // The ASCII index of the '0' character is 48. mstore8(str, add(48, mod(temp, 10))) // Keep dividing `temp` until zero. temp := div(temp, 10) // prettier-ignore if iszero(temp) { break } } let length := sub(end, str) // Move the pointer 32 bytes leftwards to make room for the length. str := sub(str, 0x20) // Store the length. mstore(str, length) } } } // File contracts/SSRWives.sol pragma solidity ^0.8.17; contract SSRWives is ERC721A, Ownable { uint256 public mintPrice = 0.07 ether; uint256 public friendMintPrice = 0.06 ether; bool public saleIsActive = false; bool public friendMintIsActive = false; uint256 public maxPerAddressDuringMint = 10; string private _baseTokenURI; uint256 public maxSupply = 3210; uint256 public amountClaimed = 0; uint256 public amountFreeMint = 250; uint256 public amountFriendClaimed = 0; uint256 public amountFriendMint = 250; mapping(address => bool) public mintedFree; address kyokoWallet = 0x3893E707eF23AD48C89d4af55d289a61f42A2535; address artWallet = 0xf7fb1039790311032c153cC65dbfD2A9FB0d84E5; address devWallet = 0xaA642262bdf212D7a111c16D7a9691F9cC1dDe37; constructor() ERC721A("SSR Wives", "SSRWIVES") {} function mintReserveTokens(uint256 numberOfTokens) public onlyOwner { _safeMint(msg.sender, numberOfTokens); require(totalSupply() <= maxSupply, "Limit reached"); } function flipSaleState() public onlyOwner { saleIsActive = !saleIsActive; } function flipFreeMintState() public onlyOwner { friendMintIsActive = !friendMintIsActive; } function setMintPrice(uint256 newPrice) public onlyOwner { mintPrice = newPrice; } function setAmountFreeMint(uint256 newAmount) public onlyOwner { amountFreeMint = newAmount; } function setMaxSupply(uint256 newAmount) public onlyOwner { maxSupply = newAmount; } function _baseURI() internal view virtual override returns (string memory) { return _baseTokenURI; } function setBaseURI(string calldata baseURI) external onlyOwner { _baseTokenURI = baseURI; } function mint(uint256 quantity) external payable { require(saleIsActive, "Sale must be active to mint"); require( quantity <= maxPerAddressDuringMint, "You can't mint that many at once" ); require( mintPrice * quantity <= msg.value, "Ether value sent is not correct" ); _mint(msg.sender, quantity); require(totalSupply() <= maxSupply, "Limit reached"); } function friendMint(uint256 quantity) external payable { require(saleIsActive, "Sale must be active to mint"); require( amountFriendClaimed < amountFriendMint, "No more free mints available" ); require( isAFriend(msg.sender), "This wallet doesn't hold any friend NFTs" ); amountFriendClaimed += 1; require( friendMintPrice * quantity <= msg.value, "Ether value sent is not correct" ); _mint(msg.sender, quantity); require(totalSupply() <= maxSupply, "Limit reached"); } function friendFreeMint() external payable { require(friendMintIsActive, "Sale must be active to mint"); require( amountClaimed < amountFreeMint, "No more discounted mints available" ); require( isAFriend(msg.sender), "This wallet doesn't hold any friend NFTs" ); require( mintedFree[msg.sender] == false, "You can only mint 1 for free" ); amountClaimed += 1; mintedFree[msg.sender] = true; _mint(msg.sender, 1); require(totalSupply() <= maxSupply, "Limit reached"); } function isAFriend(address addr) public view returns (bool) { address milady = 0x5Af0D9827E0c53E4799BB226655A1de152A425a5; address pfpplus = 0x181cde16170fac94c27584492cc9842e2Cb3BD54; address remilio = 0xD3D9ddd0CF0A5F0BFB8f7fcEAe075DF687eAEBaB; address pixelady = 0x8Fc0D90f2C45a5e7f94904075c952e0943CFCCfd; address radbro = 0xABCDB5710B88f456fED1e99025379e2969F29610; address schizo = 0xBfE47D6D4090940D1c7a0066B63d23875E3e2Ac5; address mifairy = 0x67B5eE6e29a4230177Dda07AD7848e42d89cF9a0; return ERC721(milady).balanceOf(addr) > 0 || ERC721(pfpplus).balanceOf(addr) > 0 || ERC721(remilio).balanceOf(addr) > 0 || ERC721(pixelady).balanceOf(addr) > 0 || ERC721(radbro).balanceOf(addr) > 0 || ERC721(milady).balanceOf(addr) > 0 || ERC721(schizo).balanceOf(addr) > 0 || ERC721(mifairy).balanceOf(addr) > 0; } function withdrawMoney() external onlyOwner { (bool success, ) = owner().call{value: address(this).balance}(""); require(success, "Transfer failed."); } function withdrawAll() public payable onlyOwner { uint256 third = address(this).balance / 3; require(payable(devWallet).send(third)); require(payable(kyokoWallet).send(third)); require(payable(artWallet).send(third)); } }
File 4 of 5: Archetype
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.6.0) (interfaces/IERC2981.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.0; import "../utils/introspection/IERC165Upgradeable.sol"; /** * @dev Interface for the NFT Royalty Standard. * * A standardized way to retrieve royalty payment information for non-fungible tokens (NFTs) to enable universal * support for royalty payments across all NFT marketplaces and ecosystem participants. * * _Available since v4.5._ */ interface IERC2981Upgradeable is IERC165Upgradeable { /** * @dev Returns how much royalty is owed and to whom, based on a sale price that may be denominated in any unit of * exchange. The royalty amount is denominated and should be paid in that same unit of exchange. */ function royaltyInfo(uint256 tokenId, uint256 salePrice) external view returns (address receiver, uint256 royaltyAmount); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (proxy/utils/Initializable.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.2; import "../../utils/AddressUpgradeable.sol"; /** * @dev This is a base contract to aid in writing upgradeable contracts, or any kind of contract that will be deployed * behind a proxy. Since proxied contracts do not make use of a constructor, it's common to move constructor logic to an * external initializer function, usually called `initialize`. It then becomes necessary to protect this initializer * function so it can only be called once. The {initializer} modifier provided by this contract will have this effect. * * The initialization functions use a version number. Once a version number is used, it is consumed and cannot be * reused. This mechanism prevents re-execution of each "step" but allows the creation of new initialization steps in * case an upgrade adds a module that needs to be initialized. * * For example: * * [.hljs-theme-light.nopadding] * ``` * contract MyToken is ERC20Upgradeable { * function initialize() initializer public { * __ERC20_init("MyToken", "MTK"); * } * } * contract MyTokenV2 is MyToken, ERC20PermitUpgradeable { * function initializeV2() reinitializer(2) public { * __ERC20Permit_init("MyToken"); * } * } * ``` * * TIP: To avoid leaving the proxy in an uninitialized state, the initializer function should be called as early as * possible by providing the encoded function call as the `_data` argument to {ERC1967Proxy-constructor}. * * CAUTION: When used with inheritance, manual care must be taken to not invoke a parent initializer twice, or to ensure * that all initializers are idempotent. This is not verified automatically as constructors are by Solidity. * * [CAUTION] * ==== * Avoid leaving a contract uninitialized. * * An uninitialized contract can be taken over by an attacker. This applies to both a proxy and its implementation * contract, which may impact the proxy. To prevent the implementation contract from being used, you should invoke * the {_disableInitializers} function in the constructor to automatically lock it when it is deployed: * * [.hljs-theme-light.nopadding] * ``` * /// @custom:oz-upgrades-unsafe-allow constructor * constructor() { * _disableInitializers(); * } * ``` * ==== */ abstract contract Initializable { /** * @dev Indicates that the contract has been initialized. * @custom:oz-retyped-from bool */ uint8 private _initialized; /** * @dev Indicates that the contract is in the process of being initialized. */ bool private _initializing; /** * @dev Triggered when the contract has been initialized or reinitialized. */ event Initialized(uint8 version); /** * @dev A modifier that defines a protected initializer function that can be invoked at most once. In its scope, * `onlyInitializing` functions can be used to initialize parent contracts. * * Similar to `reinitializer(1)`, except that functions marked with `initializer` can be nested in the context of a * constructor. * * Emits an {Initialized} event. */ modifier initializer() { bool isTopLevelCall = !_initializing; require( (isTopLevelCall && _initialized < 1) || (!AddressUpgradeable.isContract(address(this)) && _initialized == 1), "Initializable: contract is already initialized" ); _initialized = 1; if (isTopLevelCall) { _initializing = true; } _; if (isTopLevelCall) { _initializing = false; emit Initialized(1); } } /** * @dev A modifier that defines a protected reinitializer function that can be invoked at most once, and only if the * contract hasn't been initialized to a greater version before. In its scope, `onlyInitializing` functions can be * used to initialize parent contracts. * * A reinitializer may be used after the original initialization step. This is essential to configure modules that * are added through upgrades and that require initialization. * * When `version` is 1, this modifier is similar to `initializer`, except that functions marked with `reinitializer` * cannot be nested. If one is invoked in the context of another, execution will revert. * * Note that versions can jump in increments greater than 1; this implies that if multiple reinitializers coexist in * a contract, executing them in the right order is up to the developer or operator. * * WARNING: setting the version to 255 will prevent any future reinitialization. * * Emits an {Initialized} event. */ modifier reinitializer(uint8 version) { require(!_initializing && _initialized < version, "Initializable: contract is already initialized"); _initialized = version; _initializing = true; _; _initializing = false; emit Initialized(version); } /** * @dev Modifier to protect an initialization function so that it can only be invoked by functions with the * {initializer} and {reinitializer} modifiers, directly or indirectly. */ modifier onlyInitializing() { require(_initializing, "Initializable: contract is not initializing"); _; } /** * @dev Locks the contract, preventing any future reinitialization. This cannot be part of an initializer call. * Calling this in the constructor of a contract will prevent that contract from being initialized or reinitialized * to any version. It is recommended to use this to lock implementation contracts that are designed to be called * through proxies. * * Emits an {Initialized} event the first time it is successfully executed. */ function _disableInitializers() internal virtual { require(!_initializing, "Initializable: contract is initializing"); if (_initialized < type(uint8).max) { _initialized = type(uint8).max; emit Initialized(type(uint8).max); } } /** * @dev Internal function that returns the initialized version. Returns `_initialized` */ function _getInitializedVersion() internal view returns (uint8) { return _initialized; } /** * @dev Internal function that returns the initialized version. Returns `_initializing` */ function _isInitializing() internal view returns (bool) { return _initializing; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (token/common/ERC2981.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.0; import "../../interfaces/IERC2981Upgradeable.sol"; import "../../utils/introspection/ERC165Upgradeable.sol"; import "../../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol"; /** * @dev Implementation of the NFT Royalty Standard, a standardized way to retrieve royalty payment information. * * Royalty information can be specified globally for all token ids via {_setDefaultRoyalty}, and/or individually for * specific token ids via {_setTokenRoyalty}. The latter takes precedence over the first. * * Royalty is specified as a fraction of sale price. {_feeDenominator} is overridable but defaults to 10000, meaning the * fee is specified in basis points by default. * * IMPORTANT: ERC-2981 only specifies a way to signal royalty information and does not enforce its payment. See * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2981#optional-royalty-payments[Rationale] in the EIP. Marketplaces are expected to * voluntarily pay royalties together with sales, but note that this standard is not yet widely supported. * * _Available since v4.5._ */ abstract contract ERC2981Upgradeable is Initializable, IERC2981Upgradeable, ERC165Upgradeable { function __ERC2981_init() internal onlyInitializing { } function __ERC2981_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing { } struct RoyaltyInfo { address receiver; uint96 royaltyFraction; } RoyaltyInfo private _defaultRoyaltyInfo; mapping(uint256 => RoyaltyInfo) private _tokenRoyaltyInfo; /** * @dev See {IERC165-supportsInterface}. */ function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override(IERC165Upgradeable, ERC165Upgradeable) returns (bool) { return interfaceId == type(IERC2981Upgradeable).interfaceId || super.supportsInterface(interfaceId); } /** * @inheritdoc IERC2981Upgradeable */ function royaltyInfo(uint256 _tokenId, uint256 _salePrice) public view virtual override returns (address, uint256) { RoyaltyInfo memory royalty = _tokenRoyaltyInfo[_tokenId]; if (royalty.receiver == address(0)) { royalty = _defaultRoyaltyInfo; } uint256 royaltyAmount = (_salePrice * royalty.royaltyFraction) / _feeDenominator(); return (royalty.receiver, royaltyAmount); } /** * @dev The denominator with which to interpret the fee set in {_setTokenRoyalty} and {_setDefaultRoyalty} as a * fraction of the sale price. Defaults to 10000 so fees are expressed in basis points, but may be customized by an * override. */ function _feeDenominator() internal pure virtual returns (uint96) { return 10000; } /** * @dev Sets the royalty information that all ids in this contract will default to. * * Requirements: * * - `receiver` cannot be the zero address. * - `feeNumerator` cannot be greater than the fee denominator. */ function _setDefaultRoyalty(address receiver, uint96 feeNumerator) internal virtual { require(feeNumerator <= _feeDenominator(), "ERC2981: royalty fee will exceed salePrice"); require(receiver != address(0), "ERC2981: invalid receiver"); _defaultRoyaltyInfo = RoyaltyInfo(receiver, feeNumerator); } /** * @dev Removes default royalty information. */ function _deleteDefaultRoyalty() internal virtual { delete _defaultRoyaltyInfo; } /** * @dev Sets the royalty information for a specific token id, overriding the global default. * * Requirements: * * - `receiver` cannot be the zero address. * - `feeNumerator` cannot be greater than the fee denominator. */ function _setTokenRoyalty( uint256 tokenId, address receiver, uint96 feeNumerator ) internal virtual { require(feeNumerator <= _feeDenominator(), "ERC2981: royalty fee will exceed salePrice"); require(receiver != address(0), "ERC2981: Invalid parameters"); _tokenRoyaltyInfo[tokenId] = RoyaltyInfo(receiver, feeNumerator); } /** * @dev Resets royalty information for the token id back to the global default. */ function _resetTokenRoyalty(uint256 tokenId) internal virtual { delete _tokenRoyaltyInfo[tokenId]; } /** * @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new * variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain. * See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps */ uint256[48] private __gap; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.6.0) (token/ERC20/IERC20.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.0; /** * @dev Interface of the ERC20 standard as defined in the EIP. */ interface IERC20Upgradeable { /** * @dev Emitted when `value` tokens are moved from one account (`from`) to * another (`to`). * * Note that `value` may be zero. */ event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value); /** * @dev Emitted when the allowance of a `spender` for an `owner` is set by * a call to {approve}. `value` is the new allowance. */ event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed spender, uint256 value); /** * @dev Returns the amount of tokens in existence. */ function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Returns the amount of tokens owned by `account`. */ function balanceOf(address account) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from the caller's account to `to`. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transfer(address to, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Returns the remaining number of tokens that `spender` will be * allowed to spend on behalf of `owner` through {transferFrom}. This is * zero by default. * * This value changes when {approve} or {transferFrom} are called. */ function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the caller's tokens. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * IMPORTANT: Beware that changing an allowance with this method brings the risk * that someone may use both the old and the new allowance by unfortunate * transaction ordering. One possible solution to mitigate this race * condition is to first reduce the spender's allowance to 0 and set the * desired value afterwards: * https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729 * * Emits an {Approval} event. */ function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from `from` to `to` using the * allowance mechanism. `amount` is then deducted from the caller's * allowance. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 amount ) external returns (bool); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (utils/Address.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.1; /** * @dev Collection of functions related to the address type */ library AddressUpgradeable { /** * @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract. * * [IMPORTANT] * ==== * It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns * false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract. * * Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following * types of addresses: * * - an externally-owned account * - a contract in construction * - an address where a contract will be created * - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed * ==== * * [IMPORTANT] * ==== * You shouldn't rely on `isContract` to protect against flash loan attacks! * * Preventing calls from contracts is highly discouraged. It breaks composability, breaks support for smart wallets * like Gnosis Safe, and does not provide security since it can be circumvented by calling from a contract * constructor. * ==== */ function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) { // This method relies on extcodesize/address.code.length, which returns 0 // for contracts in construction, since the code is only stored at the end // of the constructor execution. return account.code.length > 0; } /** * @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to * `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors. * * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost * of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit * imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via * `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation. * * https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more]. * * IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be * taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using * {ReentrancyGuard} or the * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern]. */ function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal { require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance"); (bool success, ) = recipient.call{value: amount}(""); require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted"); } /** * @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A * plain `call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this * function instead. * * If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this * function (like regular Solidity function calls). * * Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value, * use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`]. * * Requirements: * * - `target` must be a contract. * - calling `target` with `data` must not revert. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) { return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, "Address: low-level call failed"); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with * `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCall( address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage ) internal returns (bytes memory) { return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], * but also transferring `value` wei to `target`. * * Requirements: * * - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`. * - the called Solidity function must be `payable`. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCallWithValue( address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value ) internal returns (bytes memory) { return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed"); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but * with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCallWithValue( address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value, string memory errorMessage ) internal returns (bytes memory) { require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call"); (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{value: value}(data); return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], * but performing a static call. * * _Available since v3.3._ */ function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) { return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed"); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`], * but performing a static call. * * _Available since v3.3._ */ function functionStaticCall( address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage ) internal view returns (bytes memory) { (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data); return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage); } /** * @dev Tool to verify that a low level call to smart-contract was successful, and revert (either by bubbling * the revert reason or using the provided one) in case of unsuccessful call or if target was not a contract. * * _Available since v4.8._ */ function verifyCallResultFromTarget( address target, bool success, bytes memory returndata, string memory errorMessage ) internal view returns (bytes memory) { if (success) { if (returndata.length == 0) { // only check isContract if the call was successful and the return data is empty // otherwise we already know that it was a contract require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract"); } return returndata; } else { _revert(returndata, errorMessage); } } /** * @dev Tool to verify that a low level call was successful, and revert if it wasn't, either by bubbling the * revert reason or using the provided one. * * _Available since v4.3._ */ function verifyCallResult( bool success, bytes memory returndata, string memory errorMessage ) internal pure returns (bytes memory) { if (success) { return returndata; } else { _revert(returndata, errorMessage); } } function _revert(bytes memory returndata, string memory errorMessage) private pure { // Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present if (returndata.length > 0) { // The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly assembly { let returndata_size := mload(returndata) revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size) } } else { revert(errorMessage); } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/ERC165.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.0; import "./IERC165Upgradeable.sol"; import "../../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol"; /** * @dev Implementation of the {IERC165} interface. * * Contracts that want to implement ERC165 should inherit from this contract and override {supportsInterface} to check * for the additional interface id that will be supported. For example: * * ```solidity * function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) { * return interfaceId == type(MyInterface).interfaceId || super.supportsInterface(interfaceId); * } * ``` * * Alternatively, {ERC165Storage} provides an easier to use but more expensive implementation. */ abstract contract ERC165Upgradeable is Initializable, IERC165Upgradeable { function __ERC165_init() internal onlyInitializing { } function __ERC165_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing { } /** * @dev See {IERC165-supportsInterface}. */ function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) { return interfaceId == type(IERC165Upgradeable).interfaceId; } /** * @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new * variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain. * See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps */ uint256[50] private __gap; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/IERC165.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.0; /** * @dev Interface of the ERC165 standard, as defined in the * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165[EIP]. * * Implementers can declare support of contract interfaces, which can then be * queried by others ({ERC165Checker}). * * For an implementation, see {ERC165}. */ interface IERC165Upgradeable { /** * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified[EIP section] * to learn more about how these ids are created. * * This function call must use less than 30 000 gas. */ function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.4; /// @notice Optimized and flexible operator filterer to abide to OpenSea's /// mandatory on-chain royalty enforcement in order for new collections to /// receive royalties. /// For more information, see: /// See: https://github.com/ProjectOpenSea/operator-filter-registry abstract contract OperatorFilterer { /// @dev The default OpenSea operator blocklist subscription. address internal constant _DEFAULT_SUBSCRIPTION = 0x3cc6CddA760b79bAfa08dF41ECFA224f810dCeB6; /// @dev The OpenSea operator filter registry. address internal constant _OPERATOR_FILTER_REGISTRY = 0x000000000000AAeB6D7670E522A718067333cd4E; /// @dev Registers the current contract to OpenSea's operator filter, /// and subscribe to the default OpenSea operator blocklist. /// Note: Will not revert nor update existing settings for repeated registration. function _registerForOperatorFiltering() internal virtual { _registerForOperatorFiltering(_DEFAULT_SUBSCRIPTION, true); } /// @dev Registers the current contract to OpenSea's operator filter. /// Note: Will not revert nor update existing settings for repeated registration. function _registerForOperatorFiltering(address subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy, bool subscribe) internal virtual { /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly assembly { let functionSelector := 0x7d3e3dbe // `registerAndSubscribe(address,address)`. // Clean the upper 96 bits of `subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy` in case they are dirty. subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy := shr(96, shl(96, subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy)) for {} iszero(subscribe) {} { if iszero(subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy) { functionSelector := 0x4420e486 // `register(address)`. break } functionSelector := 0xa0af2903 // `registerAndCopyEntries(address,address)`. break } // Store the function selector. mstore(0x00, shl(224, functionSelector)) // Store the `address(this)`. mstore(0x04, address()) // Store the `subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy`. mstore(0x24, subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy) // Register into the registry. if iszero(call(gas(), _OPERATOR_FILTER_REGISTRY, 0, 0x00, 0x44, 0x00, 0x04)) { // If the function selector has not been overwritten, // it is an out-of-gas error. if eq(shr(224, mload(0x00)), functionSelector) { // To prevent gas under-estimation. revert(0, 0) } } // Restore the part of the free memory pointer that was overwritten, // which is guaranteed to be zero, because of Solidity's memory size limits. mstore(0x24, 0) } } /// @dev Modifier to guard a function and revert if the caller is a blocked operator. modifier onlyAllowedOperator(address from) virtual { if (from != msg.sender) { if (!_isPriorityOperator(msg.sender)) { if (_operatorFilteringEnabled()) _revertIfBlocked(msg.sender); } } _; } /// @dev Modifier to guard a function from approving a blocked operator.. modifier onlyAllowedOperatorApproval(address operator) virtual { if (!_isPriorityOperator(operator)) { if (_operatorFilteringEnabled()) _revertIfBlocked(operator); } _; } /// @dev Helper function that reverts if the `operator` is blocked by the registry. function _revertIfBlocked(address operator) private view { /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly assembly { // Store the function selector of `isOperatorAllowed(address,address)`, // shifted left by 6 bytes, which is enough for 8tb of memory. // We waste 6-3 = 3 bytes to save on 6 runtime gas (PUSH1 0x224 SHL). mstore(0x00, 0xc6171134001122334455) // Store the `address(this)`. mstore(0x1a, address()) // Store the `operator`. mstore(0x3a, operator) // `isOperatorAllowed` always returns true if it does not revert. if iszero(staticcall(gas(), _OPERATOR_FILTER_REGISTRY, 0x16, 0x44, 0x00, 0x00)) { // Bubble up the revert if the staticcall reverts. returndatacopy(0x00, 0x00, returndatasize()) revert(0x00, returndatasize()) } // We'll skip checking if `from` is inside the blacklist. // Even though that can block transferring out of wrapper contracts, // we don't want tokens to be stuck. // Restore the part of the free memory pointer that was overwritten, // which is guaranteed to be zero, if less than 8tb of memory is used. mstore(0x3a, 0) } } /// @dev For deriving contracts to override, so that operator filtering /// can be turned on / off. /// Returns true by default. function _operatorFilteringEnabled() internal view virtual returns (bool) { return true; } /// @dev For deriving contracts to override, so that preferred marketplaces can /// skip operator filtering, helping users save gas. /// Returns false for all inputs by default. function _isPriorityOperator(address) internal view virtual returns (bool) { return false; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // Archetype v0.5.1 // // d8888 888 888 // d88888 888 888 // d88P888 888 888 // d88P 888 888d888 .d8888b 88888b. .d88b. 888888 888 888 88888b. .d88b. // d88P 888 888P" d88P" 888 "88b d8P Y8b 888 888 888 888 "88b d8P Y8b // d88P 888 888 888 888 888 88888888 888 888 888 888 888 88888888 // d8888888888 888 Y88b. 888 888 Y8b. Y88b. Y88b 888 888 d88P Y8b. // d88P 888 888 "Y8888P 888 888 "Y8888 "Y888 "Y88888 88888P" "Y8888 // 888 888 // Y8b d88P 888 // "Y88P" 888 pragma solidity ^0.8.4; import "./ArchetypeLogic.sol"; import "erc721a-upgradeable/contracts/ERC721AUpgradeable.sol"; import "erc721a-upgradeable/contracts/ERC721A__Initializable.sol"; import "./ERC721A__OwnableUpgradeable.sol"; import "solady/src/utils/LibString.sol"; import "closedsea/src/OperatorFilterer.sol"; import "@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/token/common/ERC2981Upgradeable.sol"; contract Archetype is ERC721A__Initializable, ERC721AUpgradeable, OperatorFilterer, ERC721A__OwnableUpgradeable, ERC2981Upgradeable { // // EVENTS // event Invited(bytes32 indexed key, bytes32 indexed cid); event Referral(address indexed affiliate, address token, uint128 wad, uint256 numMints); event Withdrawal(address indexed src, address token, uint128 wad); // // VARIABLES // mapping(bytes32 => DutchInvite) public invites; mapping(address => mapping(bytes32 => uint256)) private _minted; mapping(bytes32 => uint256) private _listSupply; mapping(address => OwnerBalance) private _ownerBalance; mapping(address => mapping(address => uint128)) private _affiliateBalance; mapping(uint256 => bytes) private _tokenMsg; Config public config; BurnConfig public burnConfig; Options public options; string public provenance; // // METHODS // function initialize( string memory name, string memory symbol, Config calldata config_, address _receiver ) external initializerERC721A { __ERC721A_init(name, symbol); // check max bps not reached and min platform fee. if ( config_.affiliateFee > MAXBPS || config_.platformFee > MAXBPS || config_.platformFee < 500 || config_.discounts.affiliateDiscount > MAXBPS || config_.affiliateSigner == address(0) || config_.maxBatchSize == 0 ) { revert InvalidConfig(); } // ensure mint tiers are correctly ordered from highest to lowest. for (uint256 i = 1; i < config_.discounts.mintTiers.length; i++) { if ( config_.discounts.mintTiers[i].mintDiscount > MAXBPS || config_.discounts.mintTiers[i].numMints > config_.discounts.mintTiers[i - 1].numMints ) { revert InvalidConfig(); } } config = config_; __Ownable_init(); if (config.ownerAltPayout != address(0)) { setDefaultRoyalty(config.ownerAltPayout, config.defaultRoyalty); } else { setDefaultRoyalty(_receiver, config.defaultRoyalty); } } // // PUBLIC // function mint( Auth calldata auth, uint256 quantity, address affiliate, bytes calldata signature ) external payable { mintTo(auth, quantity, msg.sender, affiliate, signature); } function batchMintTo( Auth calldata auth, address[] calldata toList, uint256[] calldata quantityList, address affiliate, bytes calldata signature ) external payable { if (quantityList.length != toList.length) { revert InvalidConfig(); } DutchInvite storage invite = invites[auth.key]; uint256 quantity = 0; { uint32 unitSize = invite.unitSize; for (uint256 i = 0; i < quantityList.length; i++) { if (unitSize > 1) { quantity += quantityList[i] * unitSize; } else { quantity += quantityList[i]; } } } uint256 curSupply = _totalMinted(); ArchetypeLogic.validateMint( invite, config, auth, quantity, owner(), affiliate, curSupply, _minted, _listSupply, signature ); { uint32 unitSize = invite.unitSize; for (uint256 i = 0; i < toList.length; i++) { if (unitSize > 1) { _mint(toList[i], quantityList[i] * unitSize); } else { _mint(toList[i], quantityList[i]); } } } if (invite.limit < invite.maxSupply) { _minted[msg.sender][auth.key] += quantity; } if (invite.maxSupply < config.maxSupply) { _listSupply[auth.key] += quantity; } ArchetypeLogic.updateBalances( invite, config, _ownerBalance, _affiliateBalance, affiliate, quantity ); } function mintTo( Auth calldata auth, uint256 quantity, address to, address affiliate, bytes calldata signature ) public payable { DutchInvite storage i = invites[auth.key]; if (i.unitSize > 1) { quantity = quantity * i.unitSize; } uint256 curSupply = _totalMinted(); ArchetypeLogic.validateMint( i, config, auth, quantity, owner(), affiliate, curSupply, _minted, _listSupply, signature ); _mint(to, quantity); if (i.limit < i.maxSupply) { _minted[msg.sender][auth.key] += quantity; } if (i.maxSupply < config.maxSupply) { _listSupply[auth.key] += quantity; } ArchetypeLogic.updateBalances(i, config, _ownerBalance, _affiliateBalance, affiliate, quantity); } function burnToMint(uint256[] calldata tokenIds) external { uint256 curSupply = _totalMinted(); ArchetypeLogic.validateBurnToMint(config, burnConfig, tokenIds, curSupply, _minted); for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokenIds.length; i++) { burnConfig.archetype.transferFrom( msg.sender, address(0x000000000000000000000000000000000000dEaD), tokenIds[i] ); } uint256 quantity = burnConfig.reversed ? tokenIds.length * burnConfig.ratio : tokenIds.length / burnConfig.ratio; _mint(msg.sender, quantity); if (burnConfig.limit < config.maxSupply) { _minted[msg.sender][bytes32("burn")] += quantity; } } function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (string memory) { if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert URIQueryForNonexistentToken(); return bytes(config.baseUri).length != 0 ? string(abi.encodePacked(config.baseUri, LibString.toString(tokenId))) : ""; } function withdraw() external { address[] memory tokens = new address[](1); tokens[0] = address(0); withdrawTokens(tokens); } function withdrawTokens(address[] memory tokens) public { ArchetypeLogic.withdrawTokens(config, _ownerBalance, _affiliateBalance, owner(), tokens); } function setTokenMsg(uint256 tokenId, string calldata message) external { if (msg.sender != ownerOf(tokenId)) { revert NotTokenOwner(); } _tokenMsg[tokenId] = bytes(message); } function getTokenMsg(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (string memory) { if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert URIQueryForNonexistentToken(); return string(_tokenMsg[tokenId]); } function ownerBalance() external view returns (OwnerBalance memory) { return _ownerBalance[address(0)]; } function ownerBalanceToken(address token) external view returns (OwnerBalance memory) { return _ownerBalance[token]; } function affiliateBalance(address affiliate) external view returns (uint128) { return _affiliateBalance[affiliate][address(0)]; } function affiliateBalanceToken(address affiliate, address token) external view returns (uint128) { return _affiliateBalance[affiliate][token]; } function minted(address minter, bytes32 key) external view returns (uint256) { return _minted[minter][key]; } function listSupply(bytes32 key) external view returns (uint256) { return _listSupply[key]; } function platform() external pure returns (address) { return PLATFORM; } // // OWNER ONLY // function setBaseURI(string memory baseUri) external onlyOwner { if (options.uriLocked) { revert LockedForever(); } config.baseUri = baseUri; } /// @notice the password is "forever" function lockURI(string memory password) external onlyOwner { if (keccak256(abi.encodePacked(password)) != keccak256(abi.encodePacked("forever"))) { revert WrongPassword(); } options.uriLocked = true; } /// @notice the password is "forever" // max supply cannot subceed total supply. Be careful changing. function setMaxSupply(uint32 maxSupply, string memory password) external onlyOwner { if (keccak256(abi.encodePacked(password)) != keccak256(abi.encodePacked("forever"))) { revert WrongPassword(); } if (options.maxSupplyLocked) { revert LockedForever(); } if (maxSupply < _totalMinted()) { revert MaxSupplyExceeded(); } config.maxSupply = maxSupply; } /// @notice the password is "forever" function lockMaxSupply(string memory password) external onlyOwner { if (keccak256(abi.encodePacked(password)) != keccak256(abi.encodePacked("forever"))) { revert WrongPassword(); } options.maxSupplyLocked = true; } function setAffiliateFee(uint16 affiliateFee) external onlyOwner { if (options.affiliateFeeLocked) { revert LockedForever(); } if (affiliateFee > MAXBPS) { revert InvalidConfig(); } config.affiliateFee = affiliateFee; } /// @notice the password is "forever" function lockAffiliateFee(string memory password) external onlyOwner { if (keccak256(abi.encodePacked(password)) != keccak256(abi.encodePacked("forever"))) { revert WrongPassword(); } options.affiliateFeeLocked = true; } function setDiscounts(Discount calldata discounts) external onlyOwner { if (options.discountsLocked) { revert LockedForever(); } if (discounts.affiliateDiscount > MAXBPS) { revert InvalidConfig(); } // ensure mint tiers are correctly ordered from highest to lowest. for (uint256 i = 1; i < discounts.mintTiers.length; i++) { if ( discounts.mintTiers[i].mintDiscount > MAXBPS || discounts.mintTiers[i].numMints > discounts.mintTiers[i - 1].numMints ) { revert InvalidConfig(); } } config.discounts = discounts; } /// @notice the password is "forever" function lockDiscounts(string memory password) external onlyOwner { if (keccak256(abi.encodePacked(password)) != keccak256(abi.encodePacked("forever"))) { revert WrongPassword(); } options.discountsLocked = true; } /// @notice Set BAYC-style provenance once it's calculated function setProvenanceHash(string memory provenanceHash) external onlyOwner { if (options.provenanceHashLocked) { revert LockedForever(); } provenance = provenanceHash; } /// @notice the password is "forever" function lockProvenanceHash(string memory password) external onlyOwner { if (keccak256(abi.encodePacked(password)) != keccak256(abi.encodePacked("forever"))) { revert WrongPassword(); } options.provenanceHashLocked = true; } function setOwnerAltPayout(address ownerAltPayout) external onlyOwner { if (options.ownerAltPayoutLocked) { revert LockedForever(); } config.ownerAltPayout = ownerAltPayout; } /// @notice the password is "forever" function lockOwnerAltPayout(string memory password) external onlyOwner { if (keccak256(abi.encodePacked(password)) != keccak256(abi.encodePacked("forever"))) { revert WrongPassword(); } options.ownerAltPayoutLocked = true; } function setMaxBatchSize(uint32 maxBatchSize) external onlyOwner { config.maxBatchSize = maxBatchSize; } function setInvite( bytes32 _key, bytes32 _cid, Invite calldata _invite ) external onlyOwner { invites[_key] = DutchInvite({ price: _invite.price, reservePrice: _invite.price, delta: 0, start: _invite.start, end: _invite.end, limit: _invite.limit, maxSupply: _invite.maxSupply, interval: 0, unitSize: _invite.unitSize, tokenAddress: _invite.tokenAddress }); emit Invited(_key, _cid); } function setDutchInvite( bytes32 _key, bytes32 _cid, DutchInvite memory _dutchInvite ) external onlyOwner { if (_dutchInvite.start < block.timestamp) { _dutchInvite.start = uint32(block.timestamp); } invites[_key] = _dutchInvite; emit Invited(_key, _cid); } function enableBurnToMint( address archetype, bool reversed, uint16 ratio, uint64 start, uint64 limit ) external onlyOwner { burnConfig = BurnConfig({ archetype: IERC721AUpgradeable(archetype), enabled: true, reversed: reversed, ratio: ratio, start: start, limit: limit }); } function disableBurnToMint() external onlyOwner { burnConfig = BurnConfig({ enabled: false, reversed: false, ratio: 0, archetype: IERC721AUpgradeable(address(0)), start: 0, limit: 0 }); } // // PLATFORM ONLY // function setSuperAffiliatePayout(address superAffiliatePayout) external onlyPlatform { config.superAffiliatePayout = superAffiliatePayout; } // // INTERNAL // function _startTokenId() internal view virtual override returns (uint256) { return 1; } modifier onlyPlatform() { if (msg.sender != PLATFORM) { revert NotPlatform(); } _; } // OPTIONAL ROYALTY ENFORCEMENT WITH OPENSEA function enableRoyaltyEnforcement() external onlyOwner { if (options.royaltyEnforcementLocked) { revert LockedForever(); } _registerForOperatorFiltering(); options.royaltyEnforcementEnabled = true; } function disableRoyaltyEnforcement() external onlyOwner { if (options.royaltyEnforcementLocked) { revert LockedForever(); } options.royaltyEnforcementEnabled = false; } /// @notice the password is "forever" function lockRoyaltyEnforcement(string memory password) external onlyOwner { if (keccak256(abi.encodePacked(password)) != keccak256(abi.encodePacked("forever"))) { revert WrongPassword(); } options.royaltyEnforcementLocked = true; } function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool approved) public override onlyAllowedOperatorApproval(operator) { super.setApprovalForAll(operator, approved); } function approve(address operator, uint256 tokenId) public payable override onlyAllowedOperatorApproval(operator) { super.approve(operator, tokenId); } function transferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) public payable override onlyAllowedOperator(from) { super.transferFrom(from, to, tokenId); } function safeTransferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) public payable override onlyAllowedOperator(from) { super.safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId); } function safeTransferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes memory data ) public payable override onlyAllowedOperator(from) { super.safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, data); } function _operatorFilteringEnabled() internal view override returns (bool) { return options.royaltyEnforcementEnabled; } //ERC2981 ROYALTY function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override(ERC721AUpgradeable, ERC2981Upgradeable) returns (bool) { // Supports the following `interfaceId`s: // - IERC165: 0x01ffc9a7 // - IERC721: 0x80ac58cd // - IERC721Metadata: 0x5b5e139f // - IERC2981: 0x2a55205a return ERC721AUpgradeable.supportsInterface(interfaceId) || ERC2981Upgradeable.supportsInterface(interfaceId); } function setDefaultRoyalty(address receiver, uint16 feeNumerator) public onlyOwner { config.defaultRoyalty = feeNumerator; _setDefaultRoyalty(receiver, feeNumerator); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // ArchetypeLogic v0.5.1 // // d8888 888 888 // d88888 888 888 // d88P888 888 888 // d88P 888 888d888 .d8888b 88888b. .d88b. 888888 888 888 88888b. .d88b. // d88P 888 888P" d88P" 888 "88b d8P Y8b 888 888 888 888 "88b d8P Y8b // d88P 888 888 888 888 888 88888888 888 888 888 888 888 88888888 // d8888888888 888 Y88b. 888 888 Y8b. Y88b. Y88b 888 888 d88P Y8b. // d88P 888 888 "Y8888P 888 888 "Y8888 "Y888 "Y88888 88888P" "Y8888 // 888 888 // Y8b d88P 888 // "Y88P" 888 pragma solidity ^0.8.4; import "erc721a-upgradeable/contracts/ERC721AUpgradeable.sol"; import "@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/token/ERC20/IERC20Upgradeable.sol"; import "solady/src/utils/MerkleProofLib.sol"; import "solady/src/utils/ECDSA.sol"; error InvalidConfig(); error MintNotYetStarted(); error MintEnded(); error WalletUnauthorizedToMint(); error InsufficientEthSent(); error ExcessiveEthSent(); error Erc20BalanceTooLow(); error MaxSupplyExceeded(); error ListMaxSupplyExceeded(); error NumberOfMintsExceeded(); error MintingPaused(); error InvalidReferral(); error InvalidSignature(); error BalanceEmpty(); error TransferFailed(); error MaxBatchSizeExceeded(); error BurnToMintDisabled(); error NotTokenOwner(); error NotPlatform(); error NotApprovedToTransfer(); error InvalidAmountOfTokens(); error WrongPassword(); error LockedForever(); // // STRUCTS // struct Auth { bytes32 key; bytes32[] proof; } struct MintTier { uint16 numMints; uint16 mintDiscount; //BPS } struct Discount { uint16 affiliateDiscount; //BPS MintTier[] mintTiers; } struct Config { string baseUri; address affiliateSigner; address ownerAltPayout; // optional alternative address for owner withdrawals. address superAffiliatePayout; // optional super affiliate address, will receive half of platform fee if set. uint32 maxSupply; uint32 maxBatchSize; uint16 affiliateFee; //BPS uint16 platformFee; //BPS uint16 defaultRoyalty; //BPS Discount discounts; } struct Options { bool uriLocked; bool maxSupplyLocked; bool affiliateFeeLocked; bool discountsLocked; bool ownerAltPayoutLocked; bool royaltyEnforcementEnabled; bool royaltyEnforcementLocked; bool provenanceHashLocked; } struct DutchInvite { uint128 price; uint128 reservePrice; uint128 delta; uint32 start; uint32 end; uint32 limit; uint32 maxSupply; uint32 interval; uint32 unitSize; // mint 1 get x address tokenAddress; } struct Invite { uint128 price; uint32 start; uint32 end; uint32 limit; uint32 maxSupply; uint32 unitSize; // mint 1 get x address tokenAddress; } struct OwnerBalance { uint128 owner; uint128 platform; } struct BurnConfig { IERC721AUpgradeable archetype; bool enabled; bool reversed; // side of the ratio (false=burn {ratio} get 1, true=burn 1 get {ratio}) uint16 ratio; uint64 start; uint64 limit; } // address constant PLATFORM = 0x3C44CdDdB6a900fa2b585dd299e03d12FA4293BC; // TEST (account[2]) address constant PLATFORM = 0x86B82972282Dd22348374bC63fd21620F7ED847B; uint16 constant MAXBPS = 5000; // max fee or discount is 50% library ArchetypeLogic { // // EVENTS // event Invited(bytes32 indexed key, bytes32 indexed cid); event Referral(address indexed affiliate, address token, uint128 wad, uint256 numMints); event Withdrawal(address indexed src, address token, uint128 wad); // calculate price based on affiliate usage and mint discounts function computePrice( DutchInvite storage invite, Discount storage discounts, uint256 numTokens, bool affiliateUsed ) public view returns (uint256) { uint256 price = invite.price; if (invite.interval != 0) { uint256 diff = (((block.timestamp - invite.start) / invite.interval) * invite.delta); if (price > invite.reservePrice) { if (diff > price - invite.reservePrice) { price = invite.reservePrice; } else { price = price - diff; } } else if (price < invite.reservePrice) { if (diff > invite.reservePrice - price) { price = invite.reservePrice; } else { price = price + diff; } } } uint256 cost = price * numTokens; if (affiliateUsed) { cost = cost - ((cost * discounts.affiliateDiscount) / 10000); } for (uint256 i = 0; i < discounts.mintTiers.length; i++) { if (numTokens >= discounts.mintTiers[i].numMints) { return cost = cost - ((cost * discounts.mintTiers[i].mintDiscount) / 10000); } } return cost; } function validateMint( DutchInvite storage i, Config storage config, Auth calldata auth, uint256 quantity, address owner, address affiliate, uint256 curSupply, mapping(address => mapping(bytes32 => uint256)) storage minted, mapping(bytes32 => uint256) storage listSupply, bytes calldata signature ) public view { if (affiliate != address(0)) { if (affiliate == PLATFORM || affiliate == owner || affiliate == msg.sender) { revert InvalidReferral(); } validateAffiliate(affiliate, signature, config.affiliateSigner); } if (i.limit == 0) { revert MintingPaused(); } if (!verify(auth, i.tokenAddress, msg.sender)) { revert WalletUnauthorizedToMint(); } if (block.timestamp < i.start) { revert MintNotYetStarted(); } if (i.end > i.start && block.timestamp > i.end) { revert MintEnded(); } if (i.limit < i.maxSupply) { uint256 totalAfterMint = minted[msg.sender][auth.key] + quantity; if (totalAfterMint > i.limit) { revert NumberOfMintsExceeded(); } } if (i.maxSupply < config.maxSupply) { uint256 totalAfterMint = listSupply[auth.key] + quantity; if (totalAfterMint > i.maxSupply) { revert ListMaxSupplyExceeded(); } } if (quantity > config.maxBatchSize) { revert MaxBatchSizeExceeded(); } if ((curSupply + quantity) > config.maxSupply) { revert MaxSupplyExceeded(); } uint256 cost = computePrice(i, config.discounts, quantity, affiliate != address(0)); if (i.tokenAddress != address(0)) { IERC20Upgradeable erc20Token = IERC20Upgradeable(i.tokenAddress); if (erc20Token.allowance(msg.sender, address(this)) < cost) { revert NotApprovedToTransfer(); } if (erc20Token.balanceOf(msg.sender) < cost) { revert Erc20BalanceTooLow(); } if (msg.value != 0) { revert ExcessiveEthSent(); } } else { if (msg.value < cost) { revert InsufficientEthSent(); } if (msg.value > cost) { revert ExcessiveEthSent(); } } } function validateBurnToMint( Config storage config, BurnConfig storage burnConfig, uint256[] calldata tokenIds, uint256 curSupply, mapping(address => mapping(bytes32 => uint256)) storage minted ) public view { if (!burnConfig.enabled) { revert BurnToMintDisabled(); } if (block.timestamp < burnConfig.start) { revert MintNotYetStarted(); } // check if msg.sender owns tokens and has correct approvals for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokenIds.length; i++) { if (burnConfig.archetype.ownerOf(tokenIds[i]) != msg.sender) { revert NotTokenOwner(); } } if (!burnConfig.archetype.isApprovedForAll(msg.sender, address(this))) { revert NotApprovedToTransfer(); } uint256 quantity; if (burnConfig.reversed) { quantity = tokenIds.length * burnConfig.ratio; } else { if (tokenIds.length % burnConfig.ratio != 0) { revert InvalidAmountOfTokens(); } quantity = tokenIds.length / burnConfig.ratio; } if (quantity > config.maxBatchSize) { revert MaxBatchSizeExceeded(); } if (burnConfig.limit < config.maxSupply) { uint256 totalAfterMint = minted[msg.sender][bytes32("burn")] + quantity; if (totalAfterMint > burnConfig.limit) { revert NumberOfMintsExceeded(); } } if ((curSupply + quantity) > config.maxSupply) { revert MaxSupplyExceeded(); } } function updateBalances( DutchInvite storage i, Config storage config, mapping(address => OwnerBalance) storage _ownerBalance, mapping(address => mapping(address => uint128)) storage _affiliateBalance, address affiliate, uint256 quantity ) public { address tokenAddress = i.tokenAddress; uint128 value = uint128(msg.value); if (tokenAddress != address(0)) { value = uint128(computePrice(i, config.discounts, quantity, affiliate != address(0))); } uint128 affiliateWad = 0; if (affiliate != address(0)) { affiliateWad = (value * config.affiliateFee) / 10000; _affiliateBalance[affiliate][tokenAddress] += affiliateWad; emit Referral(affiliate, tokenAddress, affiliateWad, quantity); } uint128 superAffiliateWad = 0; if (config.superAffiliatePayout != address(0)) { superAffiliateWad = ((value * config.platformFee) / 2) / 10000; _affiliateBalance[config.superAffiliatePayout][tokenAddress] += superAffiliateWad; } OwnerBalance memory balance = _ownerBalance[tokenAddress]; uint128 platformWad = ((value * config.platformFee) / 10000) - superAffiliateWad; uint128 ownerWad = value - affiliateWad - platformWad - superAffiliateWad; _ownerBalance[tokenAddress] = OwnerBalance({ owner: balance.owner + ownerWad, platform: balance.platform + platformWad }); if (tokenAddress != address(0)) { IERC20Upgradeable erc20Token = IERC20Upgradeable(tokenAddress); erc20Token.transferFrom(msg.sender, address(this), value); } } function withdrawTokens( Config storage config, mapping(address => OwnerBalance) storage _ownerBalance, mapping(address => mapping(address => uint128)) storage _affiliateBalance, address owner, address[] calldata tokens ) public { for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; i++) { address tokenAddress = tokens[i]; uint128 wad = 0; if (msg.sender == owner || msg.sender == config.ownerAltPayout || msg.sender == PLATFORM) { OwnerBalance storage balance = _ownerBalance[tokenAddress]; if (msg.sender == owner || msg.sender == config.ownerAltPayout) { wad = balance.owner; balance.owner = 0; } else { wad = balance.platform; balance.platform = 0; } } else { wad = _affiliateBalance[msg.sender][tokenAddress]; _affiliateBalance[msg.sender][tokenAddress] = 0; } if (wad == 0) { revert BalanceEmpty(); } if (tokenAddress == address(0)) { bool success = false; // send to ownerAltPayout if set and owner is withdrawing if (msg.sender == owner && config.ownerAltPayout != address(0)) { (success, ) = payable(config.ownerAltPayout).call{ value: wad }(""); } else { (success, ) = msg.sender.call{ value: wad }(""); } if (!success) { revert TransferFailed(); } } else { IERC20Upgradeable erc20Token = IERC20Upgradeable(tokenAddress); if (msg.sender == owner && config.ownerAltPayout != address(0)) { erc20Token.transfer(config.ownerAltPayout, wad); } else { erc20Token.transfer(msg.sender, wad); } } emit Withdrawal(msg.sender, tokenAddress, wad); } } function validateAffiliate( address affiliate, bytes calldata signature, address affiliateSigner ) public view { bytes32 signedMessagehash = ECDSA.toEthSignedMessageHash( keccak256(abi.encodePacked(affiliate)) ); address signer = ECDSA.recover(signedMessagehash, signature); if (signer != affiliateSigner) { revert InvalidSignature(); } } function verify( Auth calldata auth, address tokenAddress, address account ) public pure returns (bool) { // keys 0-255 and tokenAddress are public if (uint256(auth.key) <= 0xff || auth.key == keccak256(abi.encodePacked(tokenAddress))) { return true; } return MerkleProofLib.verify(auth.proof, auth.key, keccak256(abi.encodePacked(account))); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (access/Ownable.sol) import 'erc721a-upgradeable/contracts/ERC721A__Initializable.sol'; import 'erc721a-upgradeable/contracts/ERC721AUpgradeable.sol'; pragma solidity ^0.8.4; /** * @dev Contract module which provides a basic access control mechanism, where * there is an account (an owner) that can be granted exclusive access to * specific functions. * * By default, the owner account will be the one that deploys the contract. This * can later be changed with {transferOwnership}. * * This module is used through inheritance. It will make available the modifier * `onlyOwner`, which can be applied to your functions to restrict their use to * the owner. */ abstract contract ERC721A__OwnableUpgradeable is ERC721A__Initializable, ERC721AUpgradeable { address private _owner; event OwnershipTransferred(address indexed previousOwner, address indexed newOwner); /** * @dev Initializes the contract setting the deployer as the initial owner. */ function __Ownable_init() internal onlyInitializingERC721A { __Ownable_init_unchained(); } function __Ownable_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializingERC721A { _transferOwnership(_msgSenderERC721A()); } /** * @dev Returns the address of the current owner. */ function owner() public view virtual returns (address) { return _owner; } /** * @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner. */ modifier onlyOwner() { _isOwner(); _; } function _isOwner() internal view { require(owner() == _msgSenderERC721A(), "Ownable: caller is not the owner"); } /** * @dev Leaves the contract without owner. It will not be possible to call * `onlyOwner` functions anymore. Can only be called by the current owner. * * NOTE: Renouncing ownership will leave the contract without an owner, * thereby removing any functionality that is only available to the owner. */ function renounceOwnership() public virtual onlyOwner { _transferOwnership(address(0)); } /** * @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`). * Can only be called by the current owner. */ function transferOwnership(address newOwner) public virtual onlyOwner { require(newOwner != address(0), "Ownable: new owner is the zero address"); _transferOwnership(newOwner); } /** * @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`). * Internal function without access restriction. */ function _transferOwnership(address newOwner) internal virtual { address oldOwner = _owner; _owner = newOwner; emit OwnershipTransferred(oldOwner, newOwner); } /** * @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new * variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain. * See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps */ uint256[49] private __gap; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.0; /** * @dev This is a base contract to aid in writing upgradeable diamond facet contracts, or any kind of contract that will be deployed * behind a proxy. Since proxied contracts do not make use of a constructor, it's common to move constructor logic to an * external initializer function, usually called `initialize`. It then becomes necessary to protect this initializer * function so it can only be called once. The {initializer} modifier provided by this contract will have this effect. * * TIP: To avoid leaving the proxy in an uninitialized state, the initializer function should be called as early as * possible by providing the encoded function call as the `_data` argument to {ERC1967Proxy-constructor}. * * CAUTION: When used with inheritance, manual care must be taken to not invoke a parent initializer twice, or to ensure * that all initializers are idempotent. This is not verified automatically as constructors are by Solidity. */ import {ERC721A__InitializableStorage} from './ERC721A__InitializableStorage.sol'; abstract contract ERC721A__Initializable { using ERC721A__InitializableStorage for ERC721A__InitializableStorage.Layout; /** * @dev Modifier to protect an initializer function from being invoked twice. */ modifier initializerERC721A() { // If the contract is initializing we ignore whether _initialized is set in order to support multiple // inheritance patterns, but we only do this in the context of a constructor, because in other contexts the // contract may have been reentered. require( ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing ? _isConstructor() : !ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initialized, 'ERC721A__Initializable: contract is already initialized' ); bool isTopLevelCall = !ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing; if (isTopLevelCall) { ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing = true; ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initialized = true; } _; if (isTopLevelCall) { ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing = false; } } /** * @dev Modifier to protect an initialization function so that it can only be invoked by functions with the * {initializer} modifier, directly or indirectly. */ modifier onlyInitializingERC721A() { require( ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing, 'ERC721A__Initializable: contract is not initializing' ); _; } /// @dev Returns true if and only if the function is running in the constructor function _isConstructor() private view returns (bool) { // extcodesize checks the size of the code stored in an address, and // address returns the current address. Since the code is still not // deployed when running a constructor, any checks on its code size will // yield zero, making it an effective way to detect if a contract is // under construction or not. address self = address(this); uint256 cs; assembly { cs := extcodesize(self) } return cs == 0; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.0; /** * @dev This is a base storage for the initialization function for upgradeable diamond facet contracts **/ library ERC721A__InitializableStorage { struct Layout { /* * Indicates that the contract has been initialized. */ bool _initialized; /* * Indicates that the contract is in the process of being initialized. */ bool _initializing; } bytes32 internal constant STORAGE_SLOT = keccak256('ERC721A.contracts.storage.initializable.facet'); function layout() internal pure returns (Layout storage l) { bytes32 slot = STORAGE_SLOT; assembly { l.slot := slot } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.0; library ERC721AStorage { // Bypass for a `--via-ir` bug (https://github.com/chiru-labs/ERC721A/pull/364). struct TokenApprovalRef { address value; } struct Layout { // ============================================================= // STORAGE // ============================================================= // The next token ID to be minted. uint256 _currentIndex; // The number of tokens burned. uint256 _burnCounter; // Token name string _name; // Token symbol string _symbol; // Mapping from token ID to ownership details // An empty struct value does not necessarily mean the token is unowned. // See {_packedOwnershipOf} implementation for details. // // Bits Layout: // - [0..159] `addr` // - [160..223] `startTimestamp` // - [224] `burned` // - [225] `nextInitialized` // - [232..255] `extraData` mapping(uint256 => uint256) _packedOwnerships; // Mapping owner address to address data. // // Bits Layout: // - [0..63] `balance` // - [64..127] `numberMinted` // - [128..191] `numberBurned` // - [192..255] `aux` mapping(address => uint256) _packedAddressData; // Mapping from token ID to approved address. mapping(uint256 => ERC721AStorage.TokenApprovalRef) _tokenApprovals; // Mapping from owner to operator approvals mapping(address => mapping(address => bool)) _operatorApprovals; } bytes32 internal constant STORAGE_SLOT = keccak256('ERC721A.contracts.storage.ERC721A'); function layout() internal pure returns (Layout storage l) { bytes32 slot = STORAGE_SLOT; assembly { l.slot := slot } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3 // Creator: Chiru Labs pragma solidity ^0.8.4; import './IERC721AUpgradeable.sol'; import {ERC721AStorage} from './ERC721AStorage.sol'; import './ERC721A__Initializable.sol'; /** * @dev Interface of ERC721 token receiver. */ interface ERC721A__IERC721ReceiverUpgradeable { function onERC721Received( address operator, address from, uint256 tokenId, bytes calldata data ) external returns (bytes4); } /** * @title ERC721A * * @dev Implementation of the [ERC721](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-721) * Non-Fungible Token Standard, including the Metadata extension. * Optimized for lower gas during batch mints. * * Token IDs are minted in sequential order (e.g. 0, 1, 2, 3, ...) * starting from `_startTokenId()`. * * Assumptions: * * - An owner cannot have more than 2**64 - 1 (max value of uint64) of supply. * - The maximum token ID cannot exceed 2**256 - 1 (max value of uint256). */ contract ERC721AUpgradeable is ERC721A__Initializable, IERC721AUpgradeable { using ERC721AStorage for ERC721AStorage.Layout; // ============================================================= // CONSTANTS // ============================================================= // Mask of an entry in packed address data. uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY = (1 << 64) - 1; // The bit position of `numberMinted` in packed address data. uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED = 64; // The bit position of `numberBurned` in packed address data. uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED = 128; // The bit position of `aux` in packed address data. uint256 private constant _BITPOS_AUX = 192; // Mask of all 256 bits in packed address data except the 64 bits for `aux`. uint256 private constant _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 192) - 1; // The bit position of `startTimestamp` in packed ownership. uint256 private constant _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP = 160; // The bit mask of the `burned` bit in packed ownership. uint256 private constant _BITMASK_BURNED = 1 << 224; // The bit position of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership. uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 225; // The bit mask of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership. uint256 private constant _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 1 << 225; // The bit position of `extraData` in packed ownership. uint256 private constant _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA = 232; // Mask of all 256 bits in a packed ownership except the 24 bits for `extraData`. uint256 private constant _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 232) - 1; // The mask of the lower 160 bits for addresses. uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS = (1 << 160) - 1; // The maximum `quantity` that can be minted with {_mintERC2309}. // This limit is to prevent overflows on the address data entries. // For a limit of 5000, a total of 3.689e15 calls to {_mintERC2309} // is required to cause an overflow, which is unrealistic. uint256 private constant _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT = 5000; // The `Transfer` event signature is given by: // `keccak256(bytes("Transfer(address,address,uint256)"))`. bytes32 private constant _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE = 0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef; // ============================================================= // CONSTRUCTOR // ============================================================= function __ERC721A_init(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) internal onlyInitializingERC721A { __ERC721A_init_unchained(name_, symbol_); } function __ERC721A_init_unchained(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) internal onlyInitializingERC721A { ERC721AStorage.layout()._name = name_; ERC721AStorage.layout()._symbol = symbol_; ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex = _startTokenId(); } // ============================================================= // TOKEN COUNTING OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the starting token ID. * To change the starting token ID, please override this function. */ function _startTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) { return 0; } /** * @dev Returns the next token ID to be minted. */ function _nextTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) { return ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex; } /** * @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence. * Burned tokens will reduce the count. * To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}. */ function totalSupply() public view virtual override returns (uint256) { // Counter underflow is impossible as _burnCounter cannot be incremented // more than `_currentIndex - _startTokenId()` times. unchecked { return ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex - ERC721AStorage.layout()._burnCounter - _startTokenId(); } } /** * @dev Returns the total amount of tokens minted in the contract. */ function _totalMinted() internal view virtual returns (uint256) { // Counter underflow is impossible as `_currentIndex` does not decrement, // and it is initialized to `_startTokenId()`. unchecked { return ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex - _startTokenId(); } } /** * @dev Returns the total number of tokens burned. */ function _totalBurned() internal view virtual returns (uint256) { return ERC721AStorage.layout()._burnCounter; } // ============================================================= // ADDRESS DATA OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account. */ function balanceOf(address owner) public view virtual override returns (uint256) { if (owner == address(0)) revert BalanceQueryForZeroAddress(); return ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY; } /** * Returns the number of tokens minted by `owner`. */ function _numberMinted(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) { return (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY; } /** * Returns the number of tokens burned by or on behalf of `owner`. */ function _numberBurned(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) { return (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY; } /** * Returns the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used). */ function _getAux(address owner) internal view returns (uint64) { return uint64(ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_AUX); } /** * Sets the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used). * If there are multiple variables, please pack them into a uint64. */ function _setAux(address owner, uint64 aux) internal virtual { uint256 packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner]; uint256 auxCasted; // Cast `aux` with assembly to avoid redundant masking. assembly { auxCasted := aux } packed = (packed & _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT) | (auxCasted << _BITPOS_AUX); ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] = packed; } // ============================================================= // IERC165 // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding * [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified) * to learn more about how these ids are created. * * This function call must use less than 30000 gas. */ function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) { // The interface IDs are constants representing the first 4 bytes // of the XOR of all function selectors in the interface. // See: [ERC165](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165) // (e.g. `bytes4(i.functionA.selector ^ i.functionB.selector ^ ...)`) return interfaceId == 0x01ffc9a7 || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC165. interfaceId == 0x80ac58cd || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721. interfaceId == 0x5b5e139f; // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721Metadata. } // ============================================================= // IERC721Metadata // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the token collection name. */ function name() public view virtual override returns (string memory) { return ERC721AStorage.layout()._name; } /** * @dev Returns the token collection symbol. */ function symbol() public view virtual override returns (string memory) { return ERC721AStorage.layout()._symbol; } /** * @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token. */ function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (string memory) { if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert URIQueryForNonexistentToken(); string memory baseURI = _baseURI(); return bytes(baseURI).length != 0 ? string(abi.encodePacked(baseURI, _toString(tokenId))) : ''; } /** * @dev Base URI for computing {tokenURI}. If set, the resulting URI for each * token will be the concatenation of the `baseURI` and the `tokenId`. Empty * by default, it can be overridden in child contracts. */ function _baseURI() internal view virtual returns (string memory) { return ''; } // ============================================================= // OWNERSHIPS OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. */ function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) { return address(uint160(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId))); } /** * @dev Gas spent here starts off proportional to the maximum mint batch size. * It gradually moves to O(1) as tokens get transferred around over time. */ function _ownershipOf(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) { return _unpackedOwnership(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId)); } /** * @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct at `index`. */ function _ownershipAt(uint256 index) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) { return _unpackedOwnership(ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index]); } /** * @dev Initializes the ownership slot minted at `index` for efficiency purposes. */ function _initializeOwnershipAt(uint256 index) internal virtual { if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index] == 0) { ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index] = _packedOwnershipOf(index); } } /** * Returns the packed ownership data of `tokenId`. */ function _packedOwnershipOf(uint256 tokenId) private view returns (uint256 packed) { if (_startTokenId() <= tokenId) { packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId]; // If not burned. if (packed & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0) { // If the data at the starting slot does not exist, start the scan. if (packed == 0) { if (tokenId >= ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex) revert OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken(); // Invariant: // There will always be an initialized ownership slot // (i.e. `ownership.addr != address(0) && ownership.burned == false`) // before an unintialized ownership slot // (i.e. `ownership.addr == address(0) && ownership.burned == false`) // Hence, `tokenId` will not underflow. // // We can directly compare the packed value. // If the address is zero, packed will be zero. for (;;) { unchecked { packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[--tokenId]; } if (packed == 0) continue; return packed; } } // Otherwise, the data exists and is not burned. We can skip the scan. // This is possible because we have already achieved the target condition. // This saves 2143 gas on transfers of initialized tokens. return packed; } } revert OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken(); } /** * @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct from `packed`. */ function _unpackedOwnership(uint256 packed) private pure returns (TokenOwnership memory ownership) { ownership.addr = address(uint160(packed)); ownership.startTimestamp = uint64(packed >> _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP); ownership.burned = packed & _BITMASK_BURNED != 0; ownership.extraData = uint24(packed >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA); } /** * @dev Packs ownership data into a single uint256. */ function _packOwnershipData(address owner, uint256 flags) private view returns (uint256 result) { assembly { // Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean. owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS) // `owner | (block.timestamp << _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP) | flags`. result := or(owner, or(shl(_BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP, timestamp()), flags)) } } /** * @dev Returns the `nextInitialized` flag set if `quantity` equals 1. */ function _nextInitializedFlag(uint256 quantity) private pure returns (uint256 result) { // For branchless setting of the `nextInitialized` flag. assembly { // `(quantity == 1) << _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED`. result := shl(_BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED, eq(quantity, 1)) } } // ============================================================= // APPROVAL OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account. See {ERC721A-_approve}. * * Requirements: * * - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator. */ function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) public payable virtual override { _approve(to, tokenId, true); } /** * @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. */ function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) { if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken(); return ERC721AStorage.layout()._tokenApprovals[tokenId].value; } /** * @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller. * Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom} * for any token owned by the caller. * * Requirements: * * - The `operator` cannot be the caller. * * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event. */ function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool approved) public virtual override { ERC721AStorage.layout()._operatorApprovals[_msgSenderERC721A()][operator] = approved; emit ApprovalForAll(_msgSenderERC721A(), operator, approved); } /** * @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`. * * See {setApprovalForAll}. */ function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) public view virtual override returns (bool) { return ERC721AStorage.layout()._operatorApprovals[owner][operator]; } /** * @dev Returns whether `tokenId` exists. * * Tokens can be managed by their owner or approved accounts via {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * * Tokens start existing when they are minted. See {_mint}. */ function _exists(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (bool) { return _startTokenId() <= tokenId && tokenId < ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex && // If within bounds, ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId] & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0; // and not burned. } /** * @dev Returns whether `msgSender` is equal to `approvedAddress` or `owner`. */ function _isSenderApprovedOrOwner( address approvedAddress, address owner, address msgSender ) private pure returns (bool result) { assembly { // Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean. owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS) // Mask `msgSender` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean. msgSender := and(msgSender, _BITMASK_ADDRESS) // `msgSender == owner || msgSender == approvedAddress`. result := or(eq(msgSender, owner), eq(msgSender, approvedAddress)) } } /** * @dev Returns the storage slot and value for the approved address of `tokenId`. */ function _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(uint256 tokenId) private view returns (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) { ERC721AStorage.TokenApprovalRef storage tokenApproval = ERC721AStorage.layout()._tokenApprovals[tokenId]; // The following is equivalent to `approvedAddress = _tokenApprovals[tokenId].value`. assembly { approvedAddressSlot := tokenApproval.slot approvedAddress := sload(approvedAddressSlot) } } // ============================================================= // TRANSFER OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`. * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token * by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) public payable virtual override { uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId); if (address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked)) != from) revert TransferFromIncorrectOwner(); (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId); // The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition. if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A())) if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) revert TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved(); if (to == address(0)) revert TransferToZeroAddress(); _beforeTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1); // Clear approvals from the previous owner. assembly { if approvedAddress { // This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`. sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0) } } // Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for // ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow. // Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256. unchecked { // We can directly increment and decrement the balances. --ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[from]; // Updates: `balance -= 1`. ++ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[to]; // Updates: `balance += 1`. // Updates: // - `address` to the next owner. // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of transfering. // - `burned` to `false`. // - `nextInitialized` to `true`. ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData( to, _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED | _nextExtraData(from, to, prevOwnershipPacked) ); // If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) . if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) { uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1; // If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero). if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) { // If the next slot is within bounds. if (nextTokenId != ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex) { // Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`. ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked; } } } } emit Transfer(from, to, tokenId); _afterTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1); } /** * @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`. */ function safeTransferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) public payable virtual override { safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, ''); } /** * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`. * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token * by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement * {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function safeTransferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes memory _data ) public payable virtual override { transferFrom(from, to, tokenId); if (to.code.length != 0) if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(from, to, tokenId, _data)) { revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer(); } } /** * @dev Hook that is called before a set of serially-ordered token IDs * are about to be transferred. This includes minting. * And also called before burning one token. * * `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred. * `quantity` - the amount to be transferred. * * Calling conditions: * * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be * transferred to `to`. * - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`. * - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`. * - `from` and `to` are never both zero. */ function _beforeTokenTransfers( address from, address to, uint256 startTokenId, uint256 quantity ) internal virtual {} /** * @dev Hook that is called after a set of serially-ordered token IDs * have been transferred. This includes minting. * And also called after one token has been burned. * * `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred. * `quantity` - the amount to be transferred. * * Calling conditions: * * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` has been * transferred to `to`. * - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` has been minted for `to`. * - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` has been burned by `from`. * - `from` and `to` are never both zero. */ function _afterTokenTransfers( address from, address to, uint256 startTokenId, uint256 quantity ) internal virtual {} /** * @dev Private function to invoke {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received} on a target contract. * * `from` - Previous owner of the given token ID. * `to` - Target address that will receive the token. * `tokenId` - Token ID to be transferred. * `_data` - Optional data to send along with the call. * * Returns whether the call correctly returned the expected magic value. */ function _checkContractOnERC721Received( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes memory _data ) private returns (bool) { try ERC721A__IERC721ReceiverUpgradeable(to).onERC721Received(_msgSenderERC721A(), from, tokenId, _data) returns (bytes4 retval) { return retval == ERC721A__IERC721ReceiverUpgradeable(to).onERC721Received.selector; } catch (bytes memory reason) { if (reason.length == 0) { revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer(); } else { assembly { revert(add(32, reason), mload(reason)) } } } } // ============================================================= // MINT OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`. * * Requirements: * * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `quantity` must be greater than 0. * * Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint. */ function _mint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual { uint256 startTokenId = ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex; if (quantity == 0) revert MintZeroQuantity(); _beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity); // Overflows are incredibly unrealistic. // `balance` and `numberMinted` have a maximum limit of 2**64. // `tokenId` has a maximum limit of 2**256. unchecked { // Updates: // - `balance += quantity`. // - `numberMinted += quantity`. // // We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`. ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1); // Updates: // - `address` to the owner. // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting. // - `burned` to `false`. // - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`. ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData( to, _nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0) ); uint256 toMasked; uint256 end = startTokenId + quantity; // Use assembly to loop and emit the `Transfer` event for gas savings. // The duplicated `log4` removes an extra check and reduces stack juggling. // The assembly, together with the surrounding Solidity code, have been // delicately arranged to nudge the compiler into producing optimized opcodes. assembly { // Mask `to` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean. toMasked := and(to, _BITMASK_ADDRESS) // Emit the `Transfer` event. log4( 0, // Start of data (0, since no data). 0, // End of data (0, since no data). _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, // Signature. 0, // `address(0)`. toMasked, // `to`. startTokenId // `tokenId`. ) // The `iszero(eq(,))` check ensures that large values of `quantity` // that overflows uint256 will make the loop run out of gas. // The compiler will optimize the `iszero` away for performance. for { let tokenId := add(startTokenId, 1) } iszero(eq(tokenId, end)) { tokenId := add(tokenId, 1) } { // Emit the `Transfer` event. Similar to above. log4(0, 0, _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, 0, toMasked, tokenId) } } if (toMasked == 0) revert MintToZeroAddress(); ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex = end; } _afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity); } /** * @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`. * * This function is intended for efficient minting only during contract creation. * * It emits only one {ConsecutiveTransfer} as defined in * [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309), * instead of a sequence of {Transfer} event(s). * * Calling this function outside of contract creation WILL make your contract * non-compliant with the ERC721 standard. * For full ERC721 compliance, substituting ERC721 {Transfer} event(s) with the ERC2309 * {ConsecutiveTransfer} event is only permissible during contract creation. * * Requirements: * * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `quantity` must be greater than 0. * * Emits a {ConsecutiveTransfer} event. */ function _mintERC2309(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual { uint256 startTokenId = ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex; if (to == address(0)) revert MintToZeroAddress(); if (quantity == 0) revert MintZeroQuantity(); if (quantity > _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT) revert MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit(); _beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity); // Overflows are unrealistic due to the above check for `quantity` to be below the limit. unchecked { // Updates: // - `balance += quantity`. // - `numberMinted += quantity`. // // We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`. ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1); // Updates: // - `address` to the owner. // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting. // - `burned` to `false`. // - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`. ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData( to, _nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0) ); emit ConsecutiveTransfer(startTokenId, startTokenId + quantity - 1, address(0), to); ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex = startTokenId + quantity; } _afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity); } /** * @dev Safely mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`. * * Requirements: * * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement * {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called for each safe transfer. * - `quantity` must be greater than 0. * * See {_mint}. * * Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint. */ function _safeMint( address to, uint256 quantity, bytes memory _data ) internal virtual { _mint(to, quantity); unchecked { if (to.code.length != 0) { uint256 end = ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex; uint256 index = end - quantity; do { if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(address(0), to, index++, _data)) { revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer(); } } while (index < end); // Reentrancy protection. if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex != end) revert(); } } } /** * @dev Equivalent to `_safeMint(to, quantity, '')`. */ function _safeMint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual { _safeMint(to, quantity, ''); } // ============================================================= // APPROVAL OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Equivalent to `_approve(to, tokenId, false)`. */ function _approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) internal virtual { _approve(to, tokenId, false); } /** * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account. * The approval is cleared when the token is transferred. * * Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the * zero address clears previous approvals. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. * * Emits an {Approval} event. */ function _approve( address to, uint256 tokenId, bool approvalCheck ) internal virtual { address owner = ownerOf(tokenId); if (approvalCheck) if (_msgSenderERC721A() != owner) if (!isApprovedForAll(owner, _msgSenderERC721A())) { revert ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved(); } ERC721AStorage.layout()._tokenApprovals[tokenId].value = to; emit Approval(owner, to, tokenId); } // ============================================================= // BURN OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Equivalent to `_burn(tokenId, false)`. */ function _burn(uint256 tokenId) internal virtual { _burn(tokenId, false); } /** * @dev Destroys `tokenId`. * The approval is cleared when the token is burned. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function _burn(uint256 tokenId, bool approvalCheck) internal virtual { uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId); address from = address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked)); (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId); if (approvalCheck) { // The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition. if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A())) if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) revert TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved(); } _beforeTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1); // Clear approvals from the previous owner. assembly { if approvedAddress { // This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`. sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0) } } // Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for // ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow. // Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256. unchecked { // Updates: // - `balance -= 1`. // - `numberBurned += 1`. // // We can directly decrement the balance, and increment the number burned. // This is equivalent to `packed -= 1; packed += 1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED;`. ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[from] += (1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) - 1; // Updates: // - `address` to the last owner. // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of burning. // - `burned` to `true`. // - `nextInitialized` to `true`. ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData( from, (_BITMASK_BURNED | _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED) | _nextExtraData(from, address(0), prevOwnershipPacked) ); // If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) . if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) { uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1; // If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero). if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) { // If the next slot is within bounds. if (nextTokenId != ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex) { // Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`. ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked; } } } } emit Transfer(from, address(0), tokenId); _afterTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1); // Overflow not possible, as _burnCounter cannot be exceed _currentIndex times. unchecked { ERC721AStorage.layout()._burnCounter++; } } // ============================================================= // EXTRA DATA OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Directly sets the extra data for the ownership data `index`. */ function _setExtraDataAt(uint256 index, uint24 extraData) internal virtual { uint256 packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index]; if (packed == 0) revert OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData(); uint256 extraDataCasted; // Cast `extraData` with assembly to avoid redundant masking. assembly { extraDataCasted := extraData } packed = (packed & _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT) | (extraDataCasted << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA); ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index] = packed; } /** * @dev Called during each token transfer to set the 24bit `extraData` field. * Intended to be overridden by the cosumer contract. * * `previousExtraData` - the value of `extraData` before transfer. * * Calling conditions: * * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be * transferred to `to`. * - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`. * - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`. * - `from` and `to` are never both zero. */ function _extraData( address from, address to, uint24 previousExtraData ) internal view virtual returns (uint24) {} /** * @dev Returns the next extra data for the packed ownership data. * The returned result is shifted into position. */ function _nextExtraData( address from, address to, uint256 prevOwnershipPacked ) private view returns (uint256) { uint24 extraData = uint24(prevOwnershipPacked >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA); return uint256(_extraData(from, to, extraData)) << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA; } // ============================================================= // OTHER OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the message sender (defaults to `msg.sender`). * * If you are writing GSN compatible contracts, you need to override this function. */ function _msgSenderERC721A() internal view virtual returns (address) { return msg.sender; } /** * @dev Converts a uint256 to its ASCII string decimal representation. */ function _toString(uint256 value) internal pure virtual returns (string memory str) { assembly { // The maximum value of a uint256 contains 78 digits (1 byte per digit), but // we allocate 0xa0 bytes to keep the free memory pointer 32-byte word aligned. // We will need 1 word for the trailing zeros padding, 1 word for the length, // and 3 words for a maximum of 78 digits. Total: 5 * 0x20 = 0xa0. let m := add(mload(0x40), 0xa0) // Update the free memory pointer to allocate. mstore(0x40, m) // Assign the `str` to the end. str := sub(m, 0x20) // Zeroize the slot after the string. mstore(str, 0) // Cache the end of the memory to calculate the length later. let end := str // We write the string from rightmost digit to leftmost digit. // The following is essentially a do-while loop that also handles the zero case. // prettier-ignore for { let temp := value } 1 {} { str := sub(str, 1) // Write the character to the pointer. // The ASCII index of the '0' character is 48. mstore8(str, add(48, mod(temp, 10))) // Keep dividing `temp` until zero. temp := div(temp, 10) // prettier-ignore if iszero(temp) { break } } let length := sub(end, str) // Move the pointer 32 bytes leftwards to make room for the length. str := sub(str, 0x20) // Store the length. mstore(str, length) } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3 // Creator: Chiru Labs pragma solidity ^0.8.4; /** * @dev Interface of ERC721A. */ interface IERC721AUpgradeable { /** * The caller must own the token or be an approved operator. */ error ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved(); /** * The token does not exist. */ error ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken(); /** * Cannot query the balance for the zero address. */ error BalanceQueryForZeroAddress(); /** * Cannot mint to the zero address. */ error MintToZeroAddress(); /** * The quantity of tokens minted must be more than zero. */ error MintZeroQuantity(); /** * The token does not exist. */ error OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken(); /** * The caller must own the token or be an approved operator. */ error TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved(); /** * The token must be owned by `from`. */ error TransferFromIncorrectOwner(); /** * Cannot safely transfer to a contract that does not implement the * ERC721Receiver interface. */ error TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer(); /** * Cannot transfer to the zero address. */ error TransferToZeroAddress(); /** * The token does not exist. */ error URIQueryForNonexistentToken(); /** * The `quantity` minted with ERC2309 exceeds the safety limit. */ error MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit(); /** * The `extraData` cannot be set on an unintialized ownership slot. */ error OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData(); // ============================================================= // STRUCTS // ============================================================= struct TokenOwnership { // The address of the owner. address addr; // Stores the start time of ownership with minimal overhead for tokenomics. uint64 startTimestamp; // Whether the token has been burned. bool burned; // Arbitrary data similar to `startTimestamp` that can be set via {_extraData}. uint24 extraData; } // ============================================================= // TOKEN COUNTERS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence. * Burned tokens will reduce the count. * To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}. */ function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256); // ============================================================= // IERC165 // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding * [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified) * to learn more about how these ids are created. * * This function call must use less than 30000 gas. */ function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool); // ============================================================= // IERC721 // ============================================================= /** * @dev Emitted when `tokenId` token is transferred from `from` to `to`. */ event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 indexed tokenId); /** * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables `approved` to manage the `tokenId` token. */ event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed approved, uint256 indexed tokenId); /** * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables or disables * (`approved`) `operator` to manage all of its assets. */ event ApprovalForAll(address indexed owner, address indexed operator, bool approved); /** * @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account. */ function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256 balance); /** * @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. */ function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address owner); /** * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`, * checking first that contract recipients are aware of the ERC721 protocol * to prevent tokens from being forever locked. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`. * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be have been allowed to move * this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement * {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function safeTransferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes calldata data ) external payable; /** * @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`. */ function safeTransferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) external payable; /** * @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`. * * WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {safeTransferFrom} * whenever possible. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`. * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token * by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) external payable; /** * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account. * The approval is cleared when the token is transferred. * * Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the * zero address clears previous approvals. * * Requirements: * * - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator. * - `tokenId` must exist. * * Emits an {Approval} event. */ function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) external payable; /** * @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller. * Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom} * for any token owned by the caller. * * Requirements: * * - The `operator` cannot be the caller. * * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event. */ function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool _approved) external; /** * @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. */ function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address operator); /** * @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`. * * See {setApprovalForAll}. */ function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) external view returns (bool); // ============================================================= // IERC721Metadata // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the token collection name. */ function name() external view returns (string memory); /** * @dev Returns the token collection symbol. */ function symbol() external view returns (string memory); /** * @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token. */ function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (string memory); // ============================================================= // IERC2309 // ============================================================= /** * @dev Emitted when tokens in `fromTokenId` to `toTokenId` * (inclusive) is transferred from `from` to `to`, as defined in the * [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309) standard. * * See {_mintERC2309} for more details. */ event ConsecutiveTransfer(uint256 indexed fromTokenId, uint256 toTokenId, address indexed from, address indexed to); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.4; /// @notice Gas optimized ECDSA wrapper. /// @author Solady (https://github.com/vectorized/solady/blob/main/src/utils/ECDSA.sol) /// @author Modified from Solmate (https://github.com/transmissions11/solmate/blob/main/src/utils/ECDSA.sol) /// @author Modified from OpenZeppelin (https://github.com/OpenZeppelin/openzeppelin-contracts/blob/master/contracts/utils/cryptography/ECDSA.sol) library ECDSA { function recover(bytes32 hash, bytes calldata signature) internal view returns (address result) { assembly { if eq(signature.length, 65) { // Copy the free memory pointer so that we can restore it later. let m := mload(0x40) // Directly copy `r` and `s` from the calldata. calldatacopy(0x40, signature.offset, 0x40) // If `s` in lower half order, such that the signature is not malleable. // prettier-ignore if iszero(gt(mload(0x60), 0x7fffffffffffffffffffffffffffffff5d576e7357a4501ddfe92f46681b20a0)) { mstore(0x00, hash) // Compute `v` and store it in the scratch space. mstore(0x20, byte(0, calldataload(add(signature.offset, 0x40)))) pop( staticcall( gas(), // Amount of gas left for the transaction. 0x01, // Address of `ecrecover`. 0x00, // Start of input. 0x80, // Size of input. 0x40, // Start of output. 0x20 // Size of output. ) ) // Restore the zero slot. mstore(0x60, 0) // `returndatasize()` will be `0x20` upon success, and `0x00` otherwise. result := mload(sub(0x60, returndatasize())) } // Restore the free memory pointer. mstore(0x40, m) } } } function recover( bytes32 hash, bytes32 r, bytes32 vs ) internal view returns (address result) { assembly { // Copy the free memory pointer so that we can restore it later. let m := mload(0x40) // prettier-ignore let s := and(vs, 0x7fffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffff) // If `s` in lower half order, such that the signature is not malleable. // prettier-ignore if iszero(gt(s, 0x7fffffffffffffffffffffffffffffff5d576e7357a4501ddfe92f46681b20a0)) { mstore(0x00, hash) mstore(0x20, add(shr(255, vs), 27)) mstore(0x40, r) mstore(0x60, s) pop( staticcall( gas(), // Amount of gas left for the transaction. 0x01, // Address of `ecrecover`. 0x00, // Start of input. 0x80, // Size of input. 0x40, // Start of output. 0x20 // Size of output. ) ) // Restore the zero slot. mstore(0x60, 0) // `returndatasize()` will be `0x20` upon success, and `0x00` otherwise. result := mload(sub(0x60, returndatasize())) } // Restore the free memory pointer. mstore(0x40, m) } } function toEthSignedMessageHash(bytes32 hash) internal pure returns (bytes32 result) { assembly { // Store into scratch space for keccak256. mstore(0x20, hash) mstore(0x00, "\\x00\\x00\\x00\\x00\\x19Ethereum Signed Message:\ 32") // 0x40 - 0x04 = 0x3c result := keccak256(0x04, 0x3c) } } function toEthSignedMessageHash(bytes memory s) internal pure returns (bytes32 result) { assembly { // We need at most 128 bytes for Ethereum signed message header. // The max length of the ASCII reprenstation of a uint256 is 78 bytes. // The length of "\\x19Ethereum Signed Message:\ " is 26 bytes (i.e. 0x1a). // The next multiple of 32 above 78 + 26 is 128 (i.e. 0x80). // Instead of allocating, we temporarily copy the 128 bytes before the // start of `s` data to some variables. let m3 := mload(sub(s, 0x60)) let m2 := mload(sub(s, 0x40)) let m1 := mload(sub(s, 0x20)) // The length of `s` is in bytes. let sLength := mload(s) let ptr := add(s, 0x20) // `end` marks the end of the memory which we will compute the keccak256 of. let end := add(ptr, sLength) // Convert the length of the bytes to ASCII decimal representation // and store it into the memory. // prettier-ignore for { let temp := sLength } 1 {} { ptr := sub(ptr, 1) mstore8(ptr, add(48, mod(temp, 10))) temp := div(temp, 10) // prettier-ignore if iszero(temp) { break } } // Copy the header over to the memory. mstore(sub(ptr, 0x20), "\\x00\\x00\\x00\\x00\\x00\\x00\\x19Ethereum Signed Message:\ ") // Compute the keccak256 of the memory. result := keccak256(sub(ptr, 0x1a), sub(end, sub(ptr, 0x1a))) // Restore the previous memory. mstore(s, sLength) mstore(sub(s, 0x20), m1) mstore(sub(s, 0x40), m2) mstore(sub(s, 0x60), m3) } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.4; /// @notice Library for converting numbers into strings and other string operations. /// @author Solady (https://github.com/vectorized/solady/blob/main/src/utils/LibString.sol) /// @author Modified from Solmate (https://github.com/transmissions11/solmate/blob/main/src/utils/LibString.sol) library LibString { /*´:°•.°+.*•´.*:˚.°*.˚•´.°:°•.°•.*•´.*:˚.°*.˚•´.°:°•.°+.*•´.*:*/ /* CUSTOM ERRORS */ /*.•°:°.´+˚.*°.˚:*.´•*.+°.•°:´*.´•*.•°.•°:°.´:•˚°.*°.˚:*.´+°.•*/ error HexLengthInsufficient(); /*´:°•.°+.*•´.*:˚.°*.˚•´.°:°•.°•.*•´.*:˚.°*.˚•´.°:°•.°+.*•´.*:*/ /* DECIMAL OPERATIONS */ /*.•°:°.´+˚.*°.˚:*.´•*.+°.•°:´*.´•*.•°.•°:°.´:•˚°.*°.˚:*.´+°.•*/ function toString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory str) { assembly { // The maximum value of a uint256 contains 78 digits (1 byte per digit), but // we allocate 0xa0 bytes to keep the free memory pointer 32-byte word aligned. // We will need 1 word for the trailing zeros padding, 1 word for the length, // and 3 words for a maximum of 78 digits. Total: 5 * 0x20 = 0xa0. let m := add(mload(0x40), 0xa0) // Update the free memory pointer to allocate. mstore(0x40, m) // Assign the `str` to the end. str := sub(m, 0x20) // Zeroize the slot after the string. mstore(str, 0) // Cache the end of the memory to calculate the length later. let end := str // We write the string from rightmost digit to leftmost digit. // The following is essentially a do-while loop that also handles the zero case. // prettier-ignore for { let temp := value } 1 {} { str := sub(str, 1) // Write the character to the pointer. // The ASCII index of the '0' character is 48. mstore8(str, add(48, mod(temp, 10))) // Keep dividing `temp` until zero. temp := div(temp, 10) // prettier-ignore if iszero(temp) { break } } let length := sub(end, str) // Move the pointer 32 bytes leftwards to make room for the length. str := sub(str, 0x20) // Store the length. mstore(str, length) } } /*´:°•.°+.*•´.*:˚.°*.˚•´.°:°•.°•.*•´.*:˚.°*.˚•´.°:°•.°+.*•´.*:*/ /* HEXADECIMAL OPERATIONS */ /*.•°:°.´+˚.*°.˚:*.´•*.+°.•°:´*.´•*.•°.•°:°.´:•˚°.*°.˚:*.´+°.•*/ function toHexString(uint256 value, uint256 length) internal pure returns (string memory str) { assembly { let start := mload(0x40) // We need 0x20 bytes for the trailing zeros padding, `length * 2` bytes // for the digits, 0x02 bytes for the prefix, and 0x20 bytes for the length. // We add 0x20 to the total and round down to a multiple of 0x20. // (0x20 + 0x20 + 0x02 + 0x20) = 0x62. let m := add(start, and(add(shl(1, length), 0x62), not(0x1f))) // Allocate the memory. mstore(0x40, m) // Assign the `str` to the end. str := sub(m, 0x20) // Zeroize the slot after the string. mstore(str, 0) // Cache the end to calculate the length later. let end := str // Store "0123456789abcdef" in scratch space. mstore(0x0f, 0x30313233343536373839616263646566) let temp := value // We write the string from rightmost digit to leftmost digit. // The following is essentially a do-while loop that also handles the zero case. // prettier-ignore for {} 1 {} { str := sub(str, 2) mstore8(add(str, 1), mload(and(temp, 15))) mstore8(str, mload(and(shr(4, temp), 15))) temp := shr(8, temp) length := sub(length, 1) // prettier-ignore if iszero(length) { break } } if temp { // Store the function selector of `HexLengthInsufficient()`. mstore(0x00, 0x2194895a) // Revert with (offset, size). revert(0x1c, 0x04) } // Compute the string's length. let strLength := add(sub(end, str), 2) // Move the pointer and write the "0x" prefix. str := sub(str, 0x20) mstore(str, 0x3078) // Move the pointer and write the length. str := sub(str, 2) mstore(str, strLength) } } function toHexString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory str) { assembly { let start := mload(0x40) // We need 0x20 bytes for the trailing zeros padding, 0x20 bytes for the length, // 0x02 bytes for the prefix, and 0x40 bytes for the digits. // The next multiple of 0x20 above (0x20 + 0x20 + 0x02 + 0x40) is 0xa0. let m := add(start, 0xa0) // Allocate the memory. mstore(0x40, m) // Assign the `str` to the end. str := sub(m, 0x20) // Zeroize the slot after the string. mstore(str, 0) // Cache the end to calculate the length later. let end := str // Store "0123456789abcdef" in scratch space. mstore(0x0f, 0x30313233343536373839616263646566) // We write the string from rightmost digit to leftmost digit. // The following is essentially a do-while loop that also handles the zero case. // prettier-ignore for { let temp := value } 1 {} { str := sub(str, 2) mstore8(add(str, 1), mload(and(temp, 15))) mstore8(str, mload(and(shr(4, temp), 15))) temp := shr(8, temp) // prettier-ignore if iszero(temp) { break } } // Compute the string's length. let strLength := add(sub(end, str), 2) // Move the pointer and write the "0x" prefix. str := sub(str, 0x20) mstore(str, 0x3078) // Move the pointer and write the length. str := sub(str, 2) mstore(str, strLength) } } function toHexString(address value) internal pure returns (string memory str) { assembly { let start := mload(0x40) // We need 0x20 bytes for the length, 0x02 bytes for the prefix, // and 0x28 bytes for the digits. // The next multiple of 0x20 above (0x20 + 0x02 + 0x28) is 0x60. str := add(start, 0x60) // Allocate the memory. mstore(0x40, str) // Store "0123456789abcdef" in scratch space. mstore(0x0f, 0x30313233343536373839616263646566) let length := 20 // We write the string from rightmost digit to leftmost digit. // The following is essentially a do-while loop that also handles the zero case. // prettier-ignore for { let temp := value } 1 {} { str := sub(str, 2) mstore8(add(str, 1), mload(and(temp, 15))) mstore8(str, mload(and(shr(4, temp), 15))) temp := shr(8, temp) length := sub(length, 1) // prettier-ignore if iszero(length) { break } } // Move the pointer and write the "0x" prefix. str := sub(str, 32) mstore(str, 0x3078) // Move the pointer and write the length. str := sub(str, 2) mstore(str, 42) } } /*´:°•.°+.*•´.*:˚.°*.˚•´.°:°•.°•.*•´.*:˚.°*.˚•´.°:°•.°+.*•´.*:*/ /* OTHER STRING OPERATIONS */ /*.•°:°.´+˚.*°.˚:*.´•*.+°.•°:´*.´•*.•°.•°:°.´:•˚°.*°.˚:*.´+°.•*/ function replace( string memory subject, string memory search, string memory replacement ) internal pure returns (string memory result) { assembly { let subjectLength := mload(subject) let searchLength := mload(search) let replacementLength := mload(replacement) subject := add(subject, 0x20) search := add(search, 0x20) replacement := add(replacement, 0x20) result := add(mload(0x40), 0x20) let subjectEnd := add(subject, subjectLength) if iszero(gt(searchLength, subjectLength)) { let subjectSearchEnd := add(sub(subjectEnd, searchLength), 1) let h := 0 if iszero(lt(searchLength, 32)) { h := keccak256(search, searchLength) } let m := shl(3, sub(32, and(searchLength, 31))) let s := mload(search) // prettier-ignore for {} 1 {} { let t := mload(subject) // Whether the first `searchLength % 32` bytes of // `subject` and `search` matches. if iszero(shr(m, xor(t, s))) { if h { if iszero(eq(keccak256(subject, searchLength), h)) { mstore(result, t) result := add(result, 1) subject := add(subject, 1) // prettier-ignore if iszero(lt(subject, subjectSearchEnd)) { break } continue } } // Copy the `replacement` one word at a time. // prettier-ignore for { let o := 0 } 1 {} { mstore(add(result, o), mload(add(replacement, o))) o := add(o, 0x20) // prettier-ignore if iszero(lt(o, replacementLength)) { break } } result := add(result, replacementLength) subject := add(subject, searchLength) if iszero(searchLength) { mstore(result, t) result := add(result, 1) subject := add(subject, 1) } // prettier-ignore if iszero(lt(subject, subjectSearchEnd)) { break } continue } mstore(result, t) result := add(result, 1) subject := add(subject, 1) // prettier-ignore if iszero(lt(subject, subjectSearchEnd)) { break } } } let resultRemainder := result result := add(mload(0x40), 0x20) let k := add(sub(resultRemainder, result), sub(subjectEnd, subject)) // Copy the rest of the string one word at a time. // prettier-ignore for {} lt(subject, subjectEnd) {} { mstore(resultRemainder, mload(subject)) resultRemainder := add(resultRemainder, 0x20) subject := add(subject, 0x20) } // Allocate memory for the length and the bytes, // rounded up to a multiple of 32. mstore(0x40, add(result, and(add(k, 0x40), not(0x1f)))) result := sub(result, 0x20) mstore(result, k) } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.4; /// @notice Gas optimized verification of proof of inclusion for a leaf in a Merkle tree. /// @author Solady (https://github.com/vectorized/solady/blob/main/src/utils/MerkleProofLib.sol) /// @author Modified from Solmate (https://github.com/transmissions11/solmate/blob/main/src/utils/MerkleProofLib.sol) /// @author Modified from OpenZeppelin (https://github.com/OpenZeppelin/openzeppelin-contracts/blob/master/contracts/utils/cryptography/MerkleProof.sol) library MerkleProofLib { function verify( bytes32[] calldata proof, bytes32 root, bytes32 leaf ) internal pure returns (bool isValid) { assembly { if proof.length { // Left shift by 5 is equivalent to multiplying by 0x20. let end := add(proof.offset, shl(5, proof.length)) // Initialize `offset` to the offset of `proof` in the calldata. let offset := proof.offset // Iterate over proof elements to compute root hash. // prettier-ignore for {} 1 {} { // Slot of `leaf` in scratch space. // If the condition is true: 0x20, otherwise: 0x00. let scratch := shl(5, gt(leaf, calldataload(offset))) // Store elements to hash contiguously in scratch space. // Scratch space is 64 bytes (0x00 - 0x3f) and both elements are 32 bytes. mstore(scratch, leaf) mstore(xor(scratch, 0x20), calldataload(offset)) // Reuse `leaf` to store the hash to reduce stack operations. leaf := keccak256(0x00, 0x40) offset := add(offset, 0x20) // prettier-ignore if iszero(lt(offset, end)) { break } } } isValid := eq(leaf, root) } } function verifyMultiProof( bytes32[] calldata proof, bytes32 root, bytes32[] calldata leafs, bool[] calldata flags ) internal pure returns (bool isValid) { // Rebuilds the root by consuming and producing values on a queue. // The queue starts with the `leafs` array, and goes into a `hashes` array. // After the process, the last element on the queue is verified // to be equal to the `root`. // // The `flags` array denotes whether the sibling // should be popped from the queue (`flag == true`), or // should be popped from the `proof` (`flag == false`). assembly { // If the number of flags is correct. // prettier-ignore for {} eq(add(leafs.length, proof.length), add(flags.length, 1)) {} { // Left shift by 5 is equivalent to multiplying by 0x20. // Compute the end calldata offset of `leafs`. let leafsEnd := add(leafs.offset, shl(5, leafs.length)) // These are the calldata offsets. let leafsOffset := leafs.offset let flagsOffset := flags.offset let proofOffset := proof.offset // We can use the free memory space for the queue. // We don't need to allocate, since the queue is temporary. let hashesFront := mload(0x40) let hashesBack := hashesFront // This is the end of the memory for the queue. let end := add(hashesBack, shl(5, flags.length)) // For the case where `proof.length + leafs.length == 1`. if iszero(flags.length) { // If `proof.length` is zero, `leafs.length` is 1. if iszero(proof.length) { isValid := eq(calldataload(leafsOffset), root) break } // If `leafs.length` is zero, `proof.length` is 1. if iszero(leafs.length) { isValid := eq(calldataload(proofOffset), root) break } } // prettier-ignore for {} 1 {} { let a := 0 // Pops a value from the queue into `a`. switch lt(leafsOffset, leafsEnd) case 0 { // Pop from `hashes` if there are no more leafs. a := mload(hashesFront) hashesFront := add(hashesFront, 0x20) } default { // Otherwise, pop from `leafs`. a := calldataload(leafsOffset) leafsOffset := add(leafsOffset, 0x20) } let b := 0 // If the flag is false, load the next proof, // else, pops from the queue. switch calldataload(flagsOffset) case 0 { // Loads the next proof. b := calldataload(proofOffset) proofOffset := add(proofOffset, 0x20) } default { // Pops a value from the queue into `a`. switch lt(leafsOffset, leafsEnd) case 0 { // Pop from `hashes` if there are no more leafs. b := mload(hashesFront) hashesFront := add(hashesFront, 0x20) } default { // Otherwise, pop from `leafs`. b := calldataload(leafsOffset) leafsOffset := add(leafsOffset, 0x20) } } // Advance to the next flag offset. flagsOffset := add(flagsOffset, 0x20) // Slot of `a` in scratch space. // If the condition is true: 0x20, otherwise: 0x00. let scratch := shl(5, gt(a, b)) // Hash the scratch space and push the result onto the queue. mstore(scratch, a) mstore(xor(scratch, 0x20), b) mstore(hashesBack, keccak256(0x00, 0x40)) hashesBack := add(hashesBack, 0x20) // prettier-ignore if iszero(lt(hashesBack, end)) { break } } // Checks if the last value in the queue is same as the root. isValid := eq(mload(sub(hashesBack, 0x20)), root) break } } } }
File 5 of 5: Archetype
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.6.0) (interfaces/IERC2981.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.0; import "../utils/introspection/IERC165Upgradeable.sol"; /** * @dev Interface for the NFT Royalty Standard. * * A standardized way to retrieve royalty payment information for non-fungible tokens (NFTs) to enable universal * support for royalty payments across all NFT marketplaces and ecosystem participants. * * _Available since v4.5._ */ interface IERC2981Upgradeable is IERC165Upgradeable { /** * @dev Returns how much royalty is owed and to whom, based on a sale price that may be denominated in any unit of * exchange. The royalty amount is denominated and should be paid in that same unit of exchange. */ function royaltyInfo(uint256 tokenId, uint256 salePrice) external view returns (address receiver, uint256 royaltyAmount); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (proxy/utils/Initializable.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.2; import "../../utils/AddressUpgradeable.sol"; /** * @dev This is a base contract to aid in writing upgradeable contracts, or any kind of contract that will be deployed * behind a proxy. Since proxied contracts do not make use of a constructor, it's common to move constructor logic to an * external initializer function, usually called `initialize`. It then becomes necessary to protect this initializer * function so it can only be called once. The {initializer} modifier provided by this contract will have this effect. * * The initialization functions use a version number. Once a version number is used, it is consumed and cannot be * reused. This mechanism prevents re-execution of each "step" but allows the creation of new initialization steps in * case an upgrade adds a module that needs to be initialized. * * For example: * * [.hljs-theme-light.nopadding] * ``` * contract MyToken is ERC20Upgradeable { * function initialize() initializer public { * __ERC20_init("MyToken", "MTK"); * } * } * contract MyTokenV2 is MyToken, ERC20PermitUpgradeable { * function initializeV2() reinitializer(2) public { * __ERC20Permit_init("MyToken"); * } * } * ``` * * TIP: To avoid leaving the proxy in an uninitialized state, the initializer function should be called as early as * possible by providing the encoded function call as the `_data` argument to {ERC1967Proxy-constructor}. * * CAUTION: When used with inheritance, manual care must be taken to not invoke a parent initializer twice, or to ensure * that all initializers are idempotent. This is not verified automatically as constructors are by Solidity. * * [CAUTION] * ==== * Avoid leaving a contract uninitialized. * * An uninitialized contract can be taken over by an attacker. This applies to both a proxy and its implementation * contract, which may impact the proxy. To prevent the implementation contract from being used, you should invoke * the {_disableInitializers} function in the constructor to automatically lock it when it is deployed: * * [.hljs-theme-light.nopadding] * ``` * /// @custom:oz-upgrades-unsafe-allow constructor * constructor() { * _disableInitializers(); * } * ``` * ==== */ abstract contract Initializable { /** * @dev Indicates that the contract has been initialized. * @custom:oz-retyped-from bool */ uint8 private _initialized; /** * @dev Indicates that the contract is in the process of being initialized. */ bool private _initializing; /** * @dev Triggered when the contract has been initialized or reinitialized. */ event Initialized(uint8 version); /** * @dev A modifier that defines a protected initializer function that can be invoked at most once. In its scope, * `onlyInitializing` functions can be used to initialize parent contracts. * * Similar to `reinitializer(1)`, except that functions marked with `initializer` can be nested in the context of a * constructor. * * Emits an {Initialized} event. */ modifier initializer() { bool isTopLevelCall = !_initializing; require( (isTopLevelCall && _initialized < 1) || (!AddressUpgradeable.isContract(address(this)) && _initialized == 1), "Initializable: contract is already initialized" ); _initialized = 1; if (isTopLevelCall) { _initializing = true; } _; if (isTopLevelCall) { _initializing = false; emit Initialized(1); } } /** * @dev A modifier that defines a protected reinitializer function that can be invoked at most once, and only if the * contract hasn't been initialized to a greater version before. In its scope, `onlyInitializing` functions can be * used to initialize parent contracts. * * A reinitializer may be used after the original initialization step. This is essential to configure modules that * are added through upgrades and that require initialization. * * When `version` is 1, this modifier is similar to `initializer`, except that functions marked with `reinitializer` * cannot be nested. If one is invoked in the context of another, execution will revert. * * Note that versions can jump in increments greater than 1; this implies that if multiple reinitializers coexist in * a contract, executing them in the right order is up to the developer or operator. * * WARNING: setting the version to 255 will prevent any future reinitialization. * * Emits an {Initialized} event. */ modifier reinitializer(uint8 version) { require(!_initializing && _initialized < version, "Initializable: contract is already initialized"); _initialized = version; _initializing = true; _; _initializing = false; emit Initialized(version); } /** * @dev Modifier to protect an initialization function so that it can only be invoked by functions with the * {initializer} and {reinitializer} modifiers, directly or indirectly. */ modifier onlyInitializing() { require(_initializing, "Initializable: contract is not initializing"); _; } /** * @dev Locks the contract, preventing any future reinitialization. This cannot be part of an initializer call. * Calling this in the constructor of a contract will prevent that contract from being initialized or reinitialized * to any version. It is recommended to use this to lock implementation contracts that are designed to be called * through proxies. * * Emits an {Initialized} event the first time it is successfully executed. */ function _disableInitializers() internal virtual { require(!_initializing, "Initializable: contract is initializing"); if (_initialized < type(uint8).max) { _initialized = type(uint8).max; emit Initialized(type(uint8).max); } } /** * @dev Internal function that returns the initialized version. Returns `_initialized` */ function _getInitializedVersion() internal view returns (uint8) { return _initialized; } /** * @dev Internal function that returns the initialized version. Returns `_initializing` */ function _isInitializing() internal view returns (bool) { return _initializing; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (token/common/ERC2981.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.0; import "../../interfaces/IERC2981Upgradeable.sol"; import "../../utils/introspection/ERC165Upgradeable.sol"; import "../../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol"; /** * @dev Implementation of the NFT Royalty Standard, a standardized way to retrieve royalty payment information. * * Royalty information can be specified globally for all token ids via {_setDefaultRoyalty}, and/or individually for * specific token ids via {_setTokenRoyalty}. The latter takes precedence over the first. * * Royalty is specified as a fraction of sale price. {_feeDenominator} is overridable but defaults to 10000, meaning the * fee is specified in basis points by default. * * IMPORTANT: ERC-2981 only specifies a way to signal royalty information and does not enforce its payment. See * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2981#optional-royalty-payments[Rationale] in the EIP. Marketplaces are expected to * voluntarily pay royalties together with sales, but note that this standard is not yet widely supported. * * _Available since v4.5._ */ abstract contract ERC2981Upgradeable is Initializable, IERC2981Upgradeable, ERC165Upgradeable { function __ERC2981_init() internal onlyInitializing { } function __ERC2981_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing { } struct RoyaltyInfo { address receiver; uint96 royaltyFraction; } RoyaltyInfo private _defaultRoyaltyInfo; mapping(uint256 => RoyaltyInfo) private _tokenRoyaltyInfo; /** * @dev See {IERC165-supportsInterface}. */ function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override(IERC165Upgradeable, ERC165Upgradeable) returns (bool) { return interfaceId == type(IERC2981Upgradeable).interfaceId || super.supportsInterface(interfaceId); } /** * @inheritdoc IERC2981Upgradeable */ function royaltyInfo(uint256 _tokenId, uint256 _salePrice) public view virtual override returns (address, uint256) { RoyaltyInfo memory royalty = _tokenRoyaltyInfo[_tokenId]; if (royalty.receiver == address(0)) { royalty = _defaultRoyaltyInfo; } uint256 royaltyAmount = (_salePrice * royalty.royaltyFraction) / _feeDenominator(); return (royalty.receiver, royaltyAmount); } /** * @dev The denominator with which to interpret the fee set in {_setTokenRoyalty} and {_setDefaultRoyalty} as a * fraction of the sale price. Defaults to 10000 so fees are expressed in basis points, but may be customized by an * override. */ function _feeDenominator() internal pure virtual returns (uint96) { return 10000; } /** * @dev Sets the royalty information that all ids in this contract will default to. * * Requirements: * * - `receiver` cannot be the zero address. * - `feeNumerator` cannot be greater than the fee denominator. */ function _setDefaultRoyalty(address receiver, uint96 feeNumerator) internal virtual { require(feeNumerator <= _feeDenominator(), "ERC2981: royalty fee will exceed salePrice"); require(receiver != address(0), "ERC2981: invalid receiver"); _defaultRoyaltyInfo = RoyaltyInfo(receiver, feeNumerator); } /** * @dev Removes default royalty information. */ function _deleteDefaultRoyalty() internal virtual { delete _defaultRoyaltyInfo; } /** * @dev Sets the royalty information for a specific token id, overriding the global default. * * Requirements: * * - `receiver` cannot be the zero address. * - `feeNumerator` cannot be greater than the fee denominator. */ function _setTokenRoyalty( uint256 tokenId, address receiver, uint96 feeNumerator ) internal virtual { require(feeNumerator <= _feeDenominator(), "ERC2981: royalty fee will exceed salePrice"); require(receiver != address(0), "ERC2981: Invalid parameters"); _tokenRoyaltyInfo[tokenId] = RoyaltyInfo(receiver, feeNumerator); } /** * @dev Resets royalty information for the token id back to the global default. */ function _resetTokenRoyalty(uint256 tokenId) internal virtual { delete _tokenRoyaltyInfo[tokenId]; } /** * @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new * variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain. * See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps */ uint256[48] private __gap; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.6.0) (token/ERC20/IERC20.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.0; /** * @dev Interface of the ERC20 standard as defined in the EIP. */ interface IERC20Upgradeable { /** * @dev Emitted when `value` tokens are moved from one account (`from`) to * another (`to`). * * Note that `value` may be zero. */ event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value); /** * @dev Emitted when the allowance of a `spender` for an `owner` is set by * a call to {approve}. `value` is the new allowance. */ event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed spender, uint256 value); /** * @dev Returns the amount of tokens in existence. */ function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Returns the amount of tokens owned by `account`. */ function balanceOf(address account) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from the caller's account to `to`. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transfer(address to, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Returns the remaining number of tokens that `spender` will be * allowed to spend on behalf of `owner` through {transferFrom}. This is * zero by default. * * This value changes when {approve} or {transferFrom} are called. */ function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the caller's tokens. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * IMPORTANT: Beware that changing an allowance with this method brings the risk * that someone may use both the old and the new allowance by unfortunate * transaction ordering. One possible solution to mitigate this race * condition is to first reduce the spender's allowance to 0 and set the * desired value afterwards: * https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729 * * Emits an {Approval} event. */ function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from `from` to `to` using the * allowance mechanism. `amount` is then deducted from the caller's * allowance. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 amount ) external returns (bool); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (utils/Address.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.1; /** * @dev Collection of functions related to the address type */ library AddressUpgradeable { /** * @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract. * * [IMPORTANT] * ==== * It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns * false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract. * * Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following * types of addresses: * * - an externally-owned account * - a contract in construction * - an address where a contract will be created * - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed * ==== * * [IMPORTANT] * ==== * You shouldn't rely on `isContract` to protect against flash loan attacks! * * Preventing calls from contracts is highly discouraged. It breaks composability, breaks support for smart wallets * like Gnosis Safe, and does not provide security since it can be circumvented by calling from a contract * constructor. * ==== */ function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) { // This method relies on extcodesize/address.code.length, which returns 0 // for contracts in construction, since the code is only stored at the end // of the constructor execution. return account.code.length > 0; } /** * @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to * `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors. * * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost * of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit * imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via * `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation. * * https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more]. * * IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be * taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using * {ReentrancyGuard} or the * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern]. */ function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal { require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance"); (bool success, ) = recipient.call{value: amount}(""); require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted"); } /** * @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A * plain `call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this * function instead. * * If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this * function (like regular Solidity function calls). * * Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value, * use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`]. * * Requirements: * * - `target` must be a contract. * - calling `target` with `data` must not revert. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) { return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, "Address: low-level call failed"); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with * `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCall( address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage ) internal returns (bytes memory) { return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], * but also transferring `value` wei to `target`. * * Requirements: * * - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`. * - the called Solidity function must be `payable`. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCallWithValue( address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value ) internal returns (bytes memory) { return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed"); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but * with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCallWithValue( address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value, string memory errorMessage ) internal returns (bytes memory) { require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call"); (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{value: value}(data); return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], * but performing a static call. * * _Available since v3.3._ */ function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) { return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed"); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`], * but performing a static call. * * _Available since v3.3._ */ function functionStaticCall( address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage ) internal view returns (bytes memory) { (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data); return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage); } /** * @dev Tool to verify that a low level call to smart-contract was successful, and revert (either by bubbling * the revert reason or using the provided one) in case of unsuccessful call or if target was not a contract. * * _Available since v4.8._ */ function verifyCallResultFromTarget( address target, bool success, bytes memory returndata, string memory errorMessage ) internal view returns (bytes memory) { if (success) { if (returndata.length == 0) { // only check isContract if the call was successful and the return data is empty // otherwise we already know that it was a contract require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract"); } return returndata; } else { _revert(returndata, errorMessage); } } /** * @dev Tool to verify that a low level call was successful, and revert if it wasn't, either by bubbling the * revert reason or using the provided one. * * _Available since v4.3._ */ function verifyCallResult( bool success, bytes memory returndata, string memory errorMessage ) internal pure returns (bytes memory) { if (success) { return returndata; } else { _revert(returndata, errorMessage); } } function _revert(bytes memory returndata, string memory errorMessage) private pure { // Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present if (returndata.length > 0) { // The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly assembly { let returndata_size := mload(returndata) revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size) } } else { revert(errorMessage); } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/ERC165.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.0; import "./IERC165Upgradeable.sol"; import "../../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol"; /** * @dev Implementation of the {IERC165} interface. * * Contracts that want to implement ERC165 should inherit from this contract and override {supportsInterface} to check * for the additional interface id that will be supported. For example: * * ```solidity * function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) { * return interfaceId == type(MyInterface).interfaceId || super.supportsInterface(interfaceId); * } * ``` * * Alternatively, {ERC165Storage} provides an easier to use but more expensive implementation. */ abstract contract ERC165Upgradeable is Initializable, IERC165Upgradeable { function __ERC165_init() internal onlyInitializing { } function __ERC165_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing { } /** * @dev See {IERC165-supportsInterface}. */ function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) { return interfaceId == type(IERC165Upgradeable).interfaceId; } /** * @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new * variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain. * See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps */ uint256[50] private __gap; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/IERC165.sol) pragma solidity ^0.8.0; /** * @dev Interface of the ERC165 standard, as defined in the * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165[EIP]. * * Implementers can declare support of contract interfaces, which can then be * queried by others ({ERC165Checker}). * * For an implementation, see {ERC165}. */ interface IERC165Upgradeable { /** * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified[EIP section] * to learn more about how these ids are created. * * This function call must use less than 30 000 gas. */ function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.4; /// @notice Optimized and flexible operator filterer to abide to OpenSea's /// mandatory on-chain royalty enforcement in order for new collections to /// receive royalties. /// For more information, see: /// See: https://github.com/ProjectOpenSea/operator-filter-registry abstract contract OperatorFilterer { /// @dev The default OpenSea operator blocklist subscription. address internal constant _DEFAULT_SUBSCRIPTION = 0x3cc6CddA760b79bAfa08dF41ECFA224f810dCeB6; /// @dev The OpenSea operator filter registry. address internal constant _OPERATOR_FILTER_REGISTRY = 0x000000000000AAeB6D7670E522A718067333cd4E; /// @dev Registers the current contract to OpenSea's operator filter, /// and subscribe to the default OpenSea operator blocklist. /// Note: Will not revert nor update existing settings for repeated registration. function _registerForOperatorFiltering() internal virtual { _registerForOperatorFiltering(_DEFAULT_SUBSCRIPTION, true); } /// @dev Registers the current contract to OpenSea's operator filter. /// Note: Will not revert nor update existing settings for repeated registration. function _registerForOperatorFiltering(address subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy, bool subscribe) internal virtual { /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly assembly { let functionSelector := 0x7d3e3dbe // `registerAndSubscribe(address,address)`. // Clean the upper 96 bits of `subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy` in case they are dirty. subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy := shr(96, shl(96, subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy)) for {} iszero(subscribe) {} { if iszero(subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy) { functionSelector := 0x4420e486 // `register(address)`. break } functionSelector := 0xa0af2903 // `registerAndCopyEntries(address,address)`. break } // Store the function selector. mstore(0x00, shl(224, functionSelector)) // Store the `address(this)`. mstore(0x04, address()) // Store the `subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy`. mstore(0x24, subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy) // Register into the registry. if iszero(call(gas(), _OPERATOR_FILTER_REGISTRY, 0, 0x00, 0x44, 0x00, 0x04)) { // If the function selector has not been overwritten, // it is an out-of-gas error. if eq(shr(224, mload(0x00)), functionSelector) { // To prevent gas under-estimation. revert(0, 0) } } // Restore the part of the free memory pointer that was overwritten, // which is guaranteed to be zero, because of Solidity's memory size limits. mstore(0x24, 0) } } /// @dev Modifier to guard a function and revert if the caller is a blocked operator. modifier onlyAllowedOperator(address from) virtual { if (from != msg.sender) { if (!_isPriorityOperator(msg.sender)) { if (_operatorFilteringEnabled()) _revertIfBlocked(msg.sender); } } _; } /// @dev Modifier to guard a function from approving a blocked operator.. modifier onlyAllowedOperatorApproval(address operator) virtual { if (!_isPriorityOperator(operator)) { if (_operatorFilteringEnabled()) _revertIfBlocked(operator); } _; } /// @dev Helper function that reverts if the `operator` is blocked by the registry. function _revertIfBlocked(address operator) private view { /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly assembly { // Store the function selector of `isOperatorAllowed(address,address)`, // shifted left by 6 bytes, which is enough for 8tb of memory. // We waste 6-3 = 3 bytes to save on 6 runtime gas (PUSH1 0x224 SHL). mstore(0x00, 0xc6171134001122334455) // Store the `address(this)`. mstore(0x1a, address()) // Store the `operator`. mstore(0x3a, operator) // `isOperatorAllowed` always returns true if it does not revert. if iszero(staticcall(gas(), _OPERATOR_FILTER_REGISTRY, 0x16, 0x44, 0x00, 0x00)) { // Bubble up the revert if the staticcall reverts. returndatacopy(0x00, 0x00, returndatasize()) revert(0x00, returndatasize()) } // We'll skip checking if `from` is inside the blacklist. // Even though that can block transferring out of wrapper contracts, // we don't want tokens to be stuck. // Restore the part of the free memory pointer that was overwritten, // which is guaranteed to be zero, if less than 8tb of memory is used. mstore(0x3a, 0) } } /// @dev For deriving contracts to override, so that operator filtering /// can be turned on / off. /// Returns true by default. function _operatorFilteringEnabled() internal view virtual returns (bool) { return true; } /// @dev For deriving contracts to override, so that preferred marketplaces can /// skip operator filtering, helping users save gas. /// Returns false for all inputs by default. function _isPriorityOperator(address) internal view virtual returns (bool) { return false; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // Archetype v0.5.1 // // d8888 888 888 // d88888 888 888 // d88P888 888 888 // d88P 888 888d888 .d8888b 88888b. .d88b. 888888 888 888 88888b. .d88b. // d88P 888 888P" d88P" 888 "88b d8P Y8b 888 888 888 888 "88b d8P Y8b // d88P 888 888 888 888 888 88888888 888 888 888 888 888 88888888 // d8888888888 888 Y88b. 888 888 Y8b. Y88b. Y88b 888 888 d88P Y8b. // d88P 888 888 "Y8888P 888 888 "Y8888 "Y888 "Y88888 88888P" "Y8888 // 888 888 // Y8b d88P 888 // "Y88P" 888 pragma solidity ^0.8.4; import "./ArchetypeLogic.sol"; import "erc721a-upgradeable/contracts/ERC721AUpgradeable.sol"; import "erc721a-upgradeable/contracts/ERC721A__Initializable.sol"; import "./ERC721A__OwnableUpgradeable.sol"; import "solady/src/utils/LibString.sol"; import "closedsea/src/OperatorFilterer.sol"; import "@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/token/common/ERC2981Upgradeable.sol"; contract Archetype is ERC721A__Initializable, ERC721AUpgradeable, OperatorFilterer, ERC721A__OwnableUpgradeable, ERC2981Upgradeable { // // EVENTS // event Invited(bytes32 indexed key, bytes32 indexed cid); event Referral(address indexed affiliate, address token, uint128 wad, uint256 numMints); event Withdrawal(address indexed src, address token, uint128 wad); // // VARIABLES // mapping(bytes32 => DutchInvite) public invites; mapping(address => mapping(bytes32 => uint256)) private _minted; mapping(bytes32 => uint256) private _listSupply; mapping(address => OwnerBalance) private _ownerBalance; mapping(address => mapping(address => uint128)) private _affiliateBalance; mapping(uint256 => bytes) private _tokenMsg; Config public config; BurnConfig public burnConfig; Options public options; string public provenance; // // METHODS // function initialize( string memory name, string memory symbol, Config calldata config_, address _receiver ) external initializerERC721A { __ERC721A_init(name, symbol); // check max bps not reached and min platform fee. if ( config_.affiliateFee > MAXBPS || config_.platformFee > MAXBPS || config_.platformFee < 500 || config_.discounts.affiliateDiscount > MAXBPS || config_.affiliateSigner == address(0) || config_.maxBatchSize == 0 ) { revert InvalidConfig(); } // ensure mint tiers are correctly ordered from highest to lowest. for (uint256 i = 1; i < config_.discounts.mintTiers.length; i++) { if ( config_.discounts.mintTiers[i].mintDiscount > MAXBPS || config_.discounts.mintTiers[i].numMints > config_.discounts.mintTiers[i - 1].numMints ) { revert InvalidConfig(); } } config = config_; __Ownable_init(); if (config.ownerAltPayout != address(0)) { setDefaultRoyalty(config.ownerAltPayout, config.defaultRoyalty); } else { setDefaultRoyalty(_receiver, config.defaultRoyalty); } } // // PUBLIC // function mint( Auth calldata auth, uint256 quantity, address affiliate, bytes calldata signature ) external payable { mintTo(auth, quantity, msg.sender, affiliate, signature); } function batchMintTo( Auth calldata auth, address[] calldata toList, uint256[] calldata quantityList, address affiliate, bytes calldata signature ) external payable { if (quantityList.length != toList.length) { revert InvalidConfig(); } DutchInvite storage invite = invites[auth.key]; uint256 quantity = 0; { uint32 unitSize = invite.unitSize; for (uint256 i = 0; i < quantityList.length; i++) { if (unitSize > 1) { quantity += quantityList[i] * unitSize; } else { quantity += quantityList[i]; } } } uint256 curSupply = _totalMinted(); ArchetypeLogic.validateMint( invite, config, auth, quantity, owner(), affiliate, curSupply, _minted, _listSupply, signature ); { uint32 unitSize = invite.unitSize; for (uint256 i = 0; i < toList.length; i++) { if (unitSize > 1) { _mint(toList[i], quantityList[i] * unitSize); } else { _mint(toList[i], quantityList[i]); } } } if (invite.limit < invite.maxSupply) { _minted[msg.sender][auth.key] += quantity; } if (invite.maxSupply < config.maxSupply) { _listSupply[auth.key] += quantity; } ArchetypeLogic.updateBalances( invite, config, _ownerBalance, _affiliateBalance, affiliate, quantity ); } function mintTo( Auth calldata auth, uint256 quantity, address to, address affiliate, bytes calldata signature ) public payable { DutchInvite storage i = invites[auth.key]; if (i.unitSize > 1) { quantity = quantity * i.unitSize; } uint256 curSupply = _totalMinted(); ArchetypeLogic.validateMint( i, config, auth, quantity, owner(), affiliate, curSupply, _minted, _listSupply, signature ); _mint(to, quantity); if (i.limit < i.maxSupply) { _minted[msg.sender][auth.key] += quantity; } if (i.maxSupply < config.maxSupply) { _listSupply[auth.key] += quantity; } ArchetypeLogic.updateBalances(i, config, _ownerBalance, _affiliateBalance, affiliate, quantity); } function burnToMint(uint256[] calldata tokenIds) external { uint256 curSupply = _totalMinted(); ArchetypeLogic.validateBurnToMint(config, burnConfig, tokenIds, curSupply, _minted); for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokenIds.length; i++) { burnConfig.archetype.transferFrom( msg.sender, address(0x000000000000000000000000000000000000dEaD), tokenIds[i] ); } uint256 quantity = burnConfig.reversed ? tokenIds.length * burnConfig.ratio : tokenIds.length / burnConfig.ratio; _mint(msg.sender, quantity); if (burnConfig.limit < config.maxSupply) { _minted[msg.sender][bytes32("burn")] += quantity; } } function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (string memory) { if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert URIQueryForNonexistentToken(); return bytes(config.baseUri).length != 0 ? string(abi.encodePacked(config.baseUri, LibString.toString(tokenId))) : ""; } function withdraw() external { address[] memory tokens = new address[](1); tokens[0] = address(0); withdrawTokens(tokens); } function withdrawTokens(address[] memory tokens) public { ArchetypeLogic.withdrawTokens(config, _ownerBalance, _affiliateBalance, owner(), tokens); } function setTokenMsg(uint256 tokenId, string calldata message) external { if (msg.sender != ownerOf(tokenId)) { revert NotTokenOwner(); } _tokenMsg[tokenId] = bytes(message); } function getTokenMsg(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (string memory) { if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert URIQueryForNonexistentToken(); return string(_tokenMsg[tokenId]); } function ownerBalance() external view returns (OwnerBalance memory) { return _ownerBalance[address(0)]; } function ownerBalanceToken(address token) external view returns (OwnerBalance memory) { return _ownerBalance[token]; } function affiliateBalance(address affiliate) external view returns (uint128) { return _affiliateBalance[affiliate][address(0)]; } function affiliateBalanceToken(address affiliate, address token) external view returns (uint128) { return _affiliateBalance[affiliate][token]; } function minted(address minter, bytes32 key) external view returns (uint256) { return _minted[minter][key]; } function listSupply(bytes32 key) external view returns (uint256) { return _listSupply[key]; } function platform() external pure returns (address) { return PLATFORM; } // // OWNER ONLY // function setBaseURI(string memory baseUri) external onlyOwner { if (options.uriLocked) { revert LockedForever(); } config.baseUri = baseUri; } /// @notice the password is "forever" function lockURI(string memory password) external onlyOwner { if (keccak256(abi.encodePacked(password)) != keccak256(abi.encodePacked("forever"))) { revert WrongPassword(); } options.uriLocked = true; } /// @notice the password is "forever" // max supply cannot subceed total supply. Be careful changing. function setMaxSupply(uint32 maxSupply, string memory password) external onlyOwner { if (keccak256(abi.encodePacked(password)) != keccak256(abi.encodePacked("forever"))) { revert WrongPassword(); } if (options.maxSupplyLocked) { revert LockedForever(); } if (maxSupply < _totalMinted()) { revert MaxSupplyExceeded(); } config.maxSupply = maxSupply; } /// @notice the password is "forever" function lockMaxSupply(string memory password) external onlyOwner { if (keccak256(abi.encodePacked(password)) != keccak256(abi.encodePacked("forever"))) { revert WrongPassword(); } options.maxSupplyLocked = true; } function setAffiliateFee(uint16 affiliateFee) external onlyOwner { if (options.affiliateFeeLocked) { revert LockedForever(); } if (affiliateFee > MAXBPS) { revert InvalidConfig(); } config.affiliateFee = affiliateFee; } /// @notice the password is "forever" function lockAffiliateFee(string memory password) external onlyOwner { if (keccak256(abi.encodePacked(password)) != keccak256(abi.encodePacked("forever"))) { revert WrongPassword(); } options.affiliateFeeLocked = true; } function setDiscounts(Discount calldata discounts) external onlyOwner { if (options.discountsLocked) { revert LockedForever(); } if (discounts.affiliateDiscount > MAXBPS) { revert InvalidConfig(); } // ensure mint tiers are correctly ordered from highest to lowest. for (uint256 i = 1; i < discounts.mintTiers.length; i++) { if ( discounts.mintTiers[i].mintDiscount > MAXBPS || discounts.mintTiers[i].numMints > discounts.mintTiers[i - 1].numMints ) { revert InvalidConfig(); } } config.discounts = discounts; } /// @notice the password is "forever" function lockDiscounts(string memory password) external onlyOwner { if (keccak256(abi.encodePacked(password)) != keccak256(abi.encodePacked("forever"))) { revert WrongPassword(); } options.discountsLocked = true; } /// @notice Set BAYC-style provenance once it's calculated function setProvenanceHash(string memory provenanceHash) external onlyOwner { if (options.provenanceHashLocked) { revert LockedForever(); } provenance = provenanceHash; } /// @notice the password is "forever" function lockProvenanceHash(string memory password) external onlyOwner { if (keccak256(abi.encodePacked(password)) != keccak256(abi.encodePacked("forever"))) { revert WrongPassword(); } options.provenanceHashLocked = true; } function setOwnerAltPayout(address ownerAltPayout) external onlyOwner { if (options.ownerAltPayoutLocked) { revert LockedForever(); } config.ownerAltPayout = ownerAltPayout; } /// @notice the password is "forever" function lockOwnerAltPayout(string memory password) external onlyOwner { if (keccak256(abi.encodePacked(password)) != keccak256(abi.encodePacked("forever"))) { revert WrongPassword(); } options.ownerAltPayoutLocked = true; } function setMaxBatchSize(uint32 maxBatchSize) external onlyOwner { config.maxBatchSize = maxBatchSize; } function setInvite( bytes32 _key, bytes32 _cid, Invite calldata _invite ) external onlyOwner { invites[_key] = DutchInvite({ price: _invite.price, reservePrice: _invite.price, delta: 0, start: _invite.start, end: _invite.end, limit: _invite.limit, maxSupply: _invite.maxSupply, interval: 0, unitSize: _invite.unitSize, tokenAddress: _invite.tokenAddress }); emit Invited(_key, _cid); } function setDutchInvite( bytes32 _key, bytes32 _cid, DutchInvite memory _dutchInvite ) external onlyOwner { if (_dutchInvite.start < block.timestamp) { _dutchInvite.start = uint32(block.timestamp); } invites[_key] = _dutchInvite; emit Invited(_key, _cid); } function enableBurnToMint( address archetype, bool reversed, uint16 ratio, uint64 start, uint64 limit ) external onlyOwner { burnConfig = BurnConfig({ archetype: IERC721AUpgradeable(archetype), enabled: true, reversed: reversed, ratio: ratio, start: start, limit: limit }); } function disableBurnToMint() external onlyOwner { burnConfig = BurnConfig({ enabled: false, reversed: false, ratio: 0, archetype: IERC721AUpgradeable(address(0)), start: 0, limit: 0 }); } // // PLATFORM ONLY // function setSuperAffiliatePayout(address superAffiliatePayout) external onlyPlatform { config.superAffiliatePayout = superAffiliatePayout; } // // INTERNAL // function _startTokenId() internal view virtual override returns (uint256) { return 1; } modifier onlyPlatform() { if (msg.sender != PLATFORM) { revert NotPlatform(); } _; } // OPTIONAL ROYALTY ENFORCEMENT WITH OPENSEA function enableRoyaltyEnforcement() external onlyOwner { if (options.royaltyEnforcementLocked) { revert LockedForever(); } _registerForOperatorFiltering(); options.royaltyEnforcementEnabled = true; } function disableRoyaltyEnforcement() external onlyOwner { if (options.royaltyEnforcementLocked) { revert LockedForever(); } options.royaltyEnforcementEnabled = false; } /// @notice the password is "forever" function lockRoyaltyEnforcement(string memory password) external onlyOwner { if (keccak256(abi.encodePacked(password)) != keccak256(abi.encodePacked("forever"))) { revert WrongPassword(); } options.royaltyEnforcementLocked = true; } function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool approved) public override onlyAllowedOperatorApproval(operator) { super.setApprovalForAll(operator, approved); } function approve(address operator, uint256 tokenId) public payable override onlyAllowedOperatorApproval(operator) { super.approve(operator, tokenId); } function transferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) public payable override onlyAllowedOperator(from) { super.transferFrom(from, to, tokenId); } function safeTransferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) public payable override onlyAllowedOperator(from) { super.safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId); } function safeTransferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes memory data ) public payable override onlyAllowedOperator(from) { super.safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, data); } function _operatorFilteringEnabled() internal view override returns (bool) { return options.royaltyEnforcementEnabled; } //ERC2981 ROYALTY function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override(ERC721AUpgradeable, ERC2981Upgradeable) returns (bool) { // Supports the following `interfaceId`s: // - IERC165: 0x01ffc9a7 // - IERC721: 0x80ac58cd // - IERC721Metadata: 0x5b5e139f // - IERC2981: 0x2a55205a return ERC721AUpgradeable.supportsInterface(interfaceId) || ERC2981Upgradeable.supportsInterface(interfaceId); } function setDefaultRoyalty(address receiver, uint16 feeNumerator) public onlyOwner { config.defaultRoyalty = feeNumerator; _setDefaultRoyalty(receiver, feeNumerator); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // ArchetypeLogic v0.5.1 // // d8888 888 888 // d88888 888 888 // d88P888 888 888 // d88P 888 888d888 .d8888b 88888b. .d88b. 888888 888 888 88888b. .d88b. // d88P 888 888P" d88P" 888 "88b d8P Y8b 888 888 888 888 "88b d8P Y8b // d88P 888 888 888 888 888 88888888 888 888 888 888 888 88888888 // d8888888888 888 Y88b. 888 888 Y8b. Y88b. Y88b 888 888 d88P Y8b. // d88P 888 888 "Y8888P 888 888 "Y8888 "Y888 "Y88888 88888P" "Y8888 // 888 888 // Y8b d88P 888 // "Y88P" 888 pragma solidity ^0.8.4; import "erc721a-upgradeable/contracts/ERC721AUpgradeable.sol"; import "@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/token/ERC20/IERC20Upgradeable.sol"; import "solady/src/utils/MerkleProofLib.sol"; import "solady/src/utils/ECDSA.sol"; error InvalidConfig(); error MintNotYetStarted(); error MintEnded(); error WalletUnauthorizedToMint(); error InsufficientEthSent(); error ExcessiveEthSent(); error Erc20BalanceTooLow(); error MaxSupplyExceeded(); error ListMaxSupplyExceeded(); error NumberOfMintsExceeded(); error MintingPaused(); error InvalidReferral(); error InvalidSignature(); error BalanceEmpty(); error TransferFailed(); error MaxBatchSizeExceeded(); error BurnToMintDisabled(); error NotTokenOwner(); error NotPlatform(); error NotApprovedToTransfer(); error InvalidAmountOfTokens(); error WrongPassword(); error LockedForever(); // // STRUCTS // struct Auth { bytes32 key; bytes32[] proof; } struct MintTier { uint16 numMints; uint16 mintDiscount; //BPS } struct Discount { uint16 affiliateDiscount; //BPS MintTier[] mintTiers; } struct Config { string baseUri; address affiliateSigner; address ownerAltPayout; // optional alternative address for owner withdrawals. address superAffiliatePayout; // optional super affiliate address, will receive half of platform fee if set. uint32 maxSupply; uint32 maxBatchSize; uint16 affiliateFee; //BPS uint16 platformFee; //BPS uint16 defaultRoyalty; //BPS Discount discounts; } struct Options { bool uriLocked; bool maxSupplyLocked; bool affiliateFeeLocked; bool discountsLocked; bool ownerAltPayoutLocked; bool royaltyEnforcementEnabled; bool royaltyEnforcementLocked; bool provenanceHashLocked; } struct DutchInvite { uint128 price; uint128 reservePrice; uint128 delta; uint32 start; uint32 end; uint32 limit; uint32 maxSupply; uint32 interval; uint32 unitSize; // mint 1 get x address tokenAddress; } struct Invite { uint128 price; uint32 start; uint32 end; uint32 limit; uint32 maxSupply; uint32 unitSize; // mint 1 get x address tokenAddress; } struct OwnerBalance { uint128 owner; uint128 platform; } struct BurnConfig { IERC721AUpgradeable archetype; bool enabled; bool reversed; // side of the ratio (false=burn {ratio} get 1, true=burn 1 get {ratio}) uint16 ratio; uint64 start; uint64 limit; } // address constant PLATFORM = 0x3C44CdDdB6a900fa2b585dd299e03d12FA4293BC; // TEST (account[2]) address constant PLATFORM = 0x86B82972282Dd22348374bC63fd21620F7ED847B; uint16 constant MAXBPS = 5000; // max fee or discount is 50% library ArchetypeLogic { // // EVENTS // event Invited(bytes32 indexed key, bytes32 indexed cid); event Referral(address indexed affiliate, address token, uint128 wad, uint256 numMints); event Withdrawal(address indexed src, address token, uint128 wad); // calculate price based on affiliate usage and mint discounts function computePrice( DutchInvite storage invite, Discount storage discounts, uint256 numTokens, bool affiliateUsed ) public view returns (uint256) { uint256 price = invite.price; if (invite.interval != 0) { uint256 diff = (((block.timestamp - invite.start) / invite.interval) * invite.delta); if (price > invite.reservePrice) { if (diff > price - invite.reservePrice) { price = invite.reservePrice; } else { price = price - diff; } } else if (price < invite.reservePrice) { if (diff > invite.reservePrice - price) { price = invite.reservePrice; } else { price = price + diff; } } } uint256 cost = price * numTokens; if (affiliateUsed) { cost = cost - ((cost * discounts.affiliateDiscount) / 10000); } for (uint256 i = 0; i < discounts.mintTiers.length; i++) { if (numTokens >= discounts.mintTiers[i].numMints) { return cost = cost - ((cost * discounts.mintTiers[i].mintDiscount) / 10000); } } return cost; } function validateMint( DutchInvite storage i, Config storage config, Auth calldata auth, uint256 quantity, address owner, address affiliate, uint256 curSupply, mapping(address => mapping(bytes32 => uint256)) storage minted, mapping(bytes32 => uint256) storage listSupply, bytes calldata signature ) public view { if (affiliate != address(0)) { if (affiliate == PLATFORM || affiliate == owner || affiliate == msg.sender) { revert InvalidReferral(); } validateAffiliate(affiliate, signature, config.affiliateSigner); } if (i.limit == 0) { revert MintingPaused(); } if (!verify(auth, i.tokenAddress, msg.sender)) { revert WalletUnauthorizedToMint(); } if (block.timestamp < i.start) { revert MintNotYetStarted(); } if (i.end > i.start && block.timestamp > i.end) { revert MintEnded(); } if (i.limit < i.maxSupply) { uint256 totalAfterMint = minted[msg.sender][auth.key] + quantity; if (totalAfterMint > i.limit) { revert NumberOfMintsExceeded(); } } if (i.maxSupply < config.maxSupply) { uint256 totalAfterMint = listSupply[auth.key] + quantity; if (totalAfterMint > i.maxSupply) { revert ListMaxSupplyExceeded(); } } if (quantity > config.maxBatchSize) { revert MaxBatchSizeExceeded(); } if ((curSupply + quantity) > config.maxSupply) { revert MaxSupplyExceeded(); } uint256 cost = computePrice(i, config.discounts, quantity, affiliate != address(0)); if (i.tokenAddress != address(0)) { IERC20Upgradeable erc20Token = IERC20Upgradeable(i.tokenAddress); if (erc20Token.allowance(msg.sender, address(this)) < cost) { revert NotApprovedToTransfer(); } if (erc20Token.balanceOf(msg.sender) < cost) { revert Erc20BalanceTooLow(); } if (msg.value != 0) { revert ExcessiveEthSent(); } } else { if (msg.value < cost) { revert InsufficientEthSent(); } if (msg.value > cost) { revert ExcessiveEthSent(); } } } function validateBurnToMint( Config storage config, BurnConfig storage burnConfig, uint256[] calldata tokenIds, uint256 curSupply, mapping(address => mapping(bytes32 => uint256)) storage minted ) public view { if (!burnConfig.enabled) { revert BurnToMintDisabled(); } if (block.timestamp < burnConfig.start) { revert MintNotYetStarted(); } // check if msg.sender owns tokens and has correct approvals for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokenIds.length; i++) { if (burnConfig.archetype.ownerOf(tokenIds[i]) != msg.sender) { revert NotTokenOwner(); } } if (!burnConfig.archetype.isApprovedForAll(msg.sender, address(this))) { revert NotApprovedToTransfer(); } uint256 quantity; if (burnConfig.reversed) { quantity = tokenIds.length * burnConfig.ratio; } else { if (tokenIds.length % burnConfig.ratio != 0) { revert InvalidAmountOfTokens(); } quantity = tokenIds.length / burnConfig.ratio; } if (quantity > config.maxBatchSize) { revert MaxBatchSizeExceeded(); } if (burnConfig.limit < config.maxSupply) { uint256 totalAfterMint = minted[msg.sender][bytes32("burn")] + quantity; if (totalAfterMint > burnConfig.limit) { revert NumberOfMintsExceeded(); } } if ((curSupply + quantity) > config.maxSupply) { revert MaxSupplyExceeded(); } } function updateBalances( DutchInvite storage i, Config storage config, mapping(address => OwnerBalance) storage _ownerBalance, mapping(address => mapping(address => uint128)) storage _affiliateBalance, address affiliate, uint256 quantity ) public { address tokenAddress = i.tokenAddress; uint128 value = uint128(msg.value); if (tokenAddress != address(0)) { value = uint128(computePrice(i, config.discounts, quantity, affiliate != address(0))); } uint128 affiliateWad = 0; if (affiliate != address(0)) { affiliateWad = (value * config.affiliateFee) / 10000; _affiliateBalance[affiliate][tokenAddress] += affiliateWad; emit Referral(affiliate, tokenAddress, affiliateWad, quantity); } uint128 superAffiliateWad = 0; if (config.superAffiliatePayout != address(0)) { superAffiliateWad = ((value * config.platformFee) / 2) / 10000; _affiliateBalance[config.superAffiliatePayout][tokenAddress] += superAffiliateWad; } OwnerBalance memory balance = _ownerBalance[tokenAddress]; uint128 platformWad = ((value * config.platformFee) / 10000) - superAffiliateWad; uint128 ownerWad = value - affiliateWad - platformWad - superAffiliateWad; _ownerBalance[tokenAddress] = OwnerBalance({ owner: balance.owner + ownerWad, platform: balance.platform + platformWad }); if (tokenAddress != address(0)) { IERC20Upgradeable erc20Token = IERC20Upgradeable(tokenAddress); erc20Token.transferFrom(msg.sender, address(this), value); } } function withdrawTokens( Config storage config, mapping(address => OwnerBalance) storage _ownerBalance, mapping(address => mapping(address => uint128)) storage _affiliateBalance, address owner, address[] calldata tokens ) public { for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; i++) { address tokenAddress = tokens[i]; uint128 wad = 0; if (msg.sender == owner || msg.sender == config.ownerAltPayout || msg.sender == PLATFORM) { OwnerBalance storage balance = _ownerBalance[tokenAddress]; if (msg.sender == owner || msg.sender == config.ownerAltPayout) { wad = balance.owner; balance.owner = 0; } else { wad = balance.platform; balance.platform = 0; } } else { wad = _affiliateBalance[msg.sender][tokenAddress]; _affiliateBalance[msg.sender][tokenAddress] = 0; } if (wad == 0) { revert BalanceEmpty(); } if (tokenAddress == address(0)) { bool success = false; // send to ownerAltPayout if set and owner is withdrawing if (msg.sender == owner && config.ownerAltPayout != address(0)) { (success, ) = payable(config.ownerAltPayout).call{ value: wad }(""); } else { (success, ) = msg.sender.call{ value: wad }(""); } if (!success) { revert TransferFailed(); } } else { IERC20Upgradeable erc20Token = IERC20Upgradeable(tokenAddress); if (msg.sender == owner && config.ownerAltPayout != address(0)) { erc20Token.transfer(config.ownerAltPayout, wad); } else { erc20Token.transfer(msg.sender, wad); } } emit Withdrawal(msg.sender, tokenAddress, wad); } } function validateAffiliate( address affiliate, bytes calldata signature, address affiliateSigner ) public view { bytes32 signedMessagehash = ECDSA.toEthSignedMessageHash( keccak256(abi.encodePacked(affiliate)) ); address signer = ECDSA.recover(signedMessagehash, signature); if (signer != affiliateSigner) { revert InvalidSignature(); } } function verify( Auth calldata auth, address tokenAddress, address account ) public pure returns (bool) { // keys 0-255 and tokenAddress are public if (uint256(auth.key) <= 0xff || auth.key == keccak256(abi.encodePacked(tokenAddress))) { return true; } return MerkleProofLib.verify(auth.proof, auth.key, keccak256(abi.encodePacked(account))); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (access/Ownable.sol) import 'erc721a-upgradeable/contracts/ERC721A__Initializable.sol'; import 'erc721a-upgradeable/contracts/ERC721AUpgradeable.sol'; pragma solidity ^0.8.4; /** * @dev Contract module which provides a basic access control mechanism, where * there is an account (an owner) that can be granted exclusive access to * specific functions. * * By default, the owner account will be the one that deploys the contract. This * can later be changed with {transferOwnership}. * * This module is used through inheritance. It will make available the modifier * `onlyOwner`, which can be applied to your functions to restrict their use to * the owner. */ abstract contract ERC721A__OwnableUpgradeable is ERC721A__Initializable, ERC721AUpgradeable { address private _owner; event OwnershipTransferred(address indexed previousOwner, address indexed newOwner); /** * @dev Initializes the contract setting the deployer as the initial owner. */ function __Ownable_init() internal onlyInitializingERC721A { __Ownable_init_unchained(); } function __Ownable_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializingERC721A { _transferOwnership(_msgSenderERC721A()); } /** * @dev Returns the address of the current owner. */ function owner() public view virtual returns (address) { return _owner; } /** * @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner. */ modifier onlyOwner() { _isOwner(); _; } function _isOwner() internal view { require(owner() == _msgSenderERC721A(), "Ownable: caller is not the owner"); } /** * @dev Leaves the contract without owner. It will not be possible to call * `onlyOwner` functions anymore. Can only be called by the current owner. * * NOTE: Renouncing ownership will leave the contract without an owner, * thereby removing any functionality that is only available to the owner. */ function renounceOwnership() public virtual onlyOwner { _transferOwnership(address(0)); } /** * @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`). * Can only be called by the current owner. */ function transferOwnership(address newOwner) public virtual onlyOwner { require(newOwner != address(0), "Ownable: new owner is the zero address"); _transferOwnership(newOwner); } /** * @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`). * Internal function without access restriction. */ function _transferOwnership(address newOwner) internal virtual { address oldOwner = _owner; _owner = newOwner; emit OwnershipTransferred(oldOwner, newOwner); } /** * @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new * variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain. * See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps */ uint256[49] private __gap; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.0; /** * @dev This is a base contract to aid in writing upgradeable diamond facet contracts, or any kind of contract that will be deployed * behind a proxy. Since proxied contracts do not make use of a constructor, it's common to move constructor logic to an * external initializer function, usually called `initialize`. It then becomes necessary to protect this initializer * function so it can only be called once. The {initializer} modifier provided by this contract will have this effect. * * TIP: To avoid leaving the proxy in an uninitialized state, the initializer function should be called as early as * possible by providing the encoded function call as the `_data` argument to {ERC1967Proxy-constructor}. * * CAUTION: When used with inheritance, manual care must be taken to not invoke a parent initializer twice, or to ensure * that all initializers are idempotent. This is not verified automatically as constructors are by Solidity. */ import {ERC721A__InitializableStorage} from './ERC721A__InitializableStorage.sol'; abstract contract ERC721A__Initializable { using ERC721A__InitializableStorage for ERC721A__InitializableStorage.Layout; /** * @dev Modifier to protect an initializer function from being invoked twice. */ modifier initializerERC721A() { // If the contract is initializing we ignore whether _initialized is set in order to support multiple // inheritance patterns, but we only do this in the context of a constructor, because in other contexts the // contract may have been reentered. require( ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing ? _isConstructor() : !ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initialized, 'ERC721A__Initializable: contract is already initialized' ); bool isTopLevelCall = !ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing; if (isTopLevelCall) { ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing = true; ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initialized = true; } _; if (isTopLevelCall) { ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing = false; } } /** * @dev Modifier to protect an initialization function so that it can only be invoked by functions with the * {initializer} modifier, directly or indirectly. */ modifier onlyInitializingERC721A() { require( ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing, 'ERC721A__Initializable: contract is not initializing' ); _; } /// @dev Returns true if and only if the function is running in the constructor function _isConstructor() private view returns (bool) { // extcodesize checks the size of the code stored in an address, and // address returns the current address. Since the code is still not // deployed when running a constructor, any checks on its code size will // yield zero, making it an effective way to detect if a contract is // under construction or not. address self = address(this); uint256 cs; assembly { cs := extcodesize(self) } return cs == 0; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.0; /** * @dev This is a base storage for the initialization function for upgradeable diamond facet contracts **/ library ERC721A__InitializableStorage { struct Layout { /* * Indicates that the contract has been initialized. */ bool _initialized; /* * Indicates that the contract is in the process of being initialized. */ bool _initializing; } bytes32 internal constant STORAGE_SLOT = keccak256('ERC721A.contracts.storage.initializable.facet'); function layout() internal pure returns (Layout storage l) { bytes32 slot = STORAGE_SLOT; assembly { l.slot := slot } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.0; library ERC721AStorage { // Bypass for a `--via-ir` bug (https://github.com/chiru-labs/ERC721A/pull/364). struct TokenApprovalRef { address value; } struct Layout { // ============================================================= // STORAGE // ============================================================= // The next token ID to be minted. uint256 _currentIndex; // The number of tokens burned. uint256 _burnCounter; // Token name string _name; // Token symbol string _symbol; // Mapping from token ID to ownership details // An empty struct value does not necessarily mean the token is unowned. // See {_packedOwnershipOf} implementation for details. // // Bits Layout: // - [0..159] `addr` // - [160..223] `startTimestamp` // - [224] `burned` // - [225] `nextInitialized` // - [232..255] `extraData` mapping(uint256 => uint256) _packedOwnerships; // Mapping owner address to address data. // // Bits Layout: // - [0..63] `balance` // - [64..127] `numberMinted` // - [128..191] `numberBurned` // - [192..255] `aux` mapping(address => uint256) _packedAddressData; // Mapping from token ID to approved address. mapping(uint256 => ERC721AStorage.TokenApprovalRef) _tokenApprovals; // Mapping from owner to operator approvals mapping(address => mapping(address => bool)) _operatorApprovals; } bytes32 internal constant STORAGE_SLOT = keccak256('ERC721A.contracts.storage.ERC721A'); function layout() internal pure returns (Layout storage l) { bytes32 slot = STORAGE_SLOT; assembly { l.slot := slot } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3 // Creator: Chiru Labs pragma solidity ^0.8.4; import './IERC721AUpgradeable.sol'; import {ERC721AStorage} from './ERC721AStorage.sol'; import './ERC721A__Initializable.sol'; /** * @dev Interface of ERC721 token receiver. */ interface ERC721A__IERC721ReceiverUpgradeable { function onERC721Received( address operator, address from, uint256 tokenId, bytes calldata data ) external returns (bytes4); } /** * @title ERC721A * * @dev Implementation of the [ERC721](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-721) * Non-Fungible Token Standard, including the Metadata extension. * Optimized for lower gas during batch mints. * * Token IDs are minted in sequential order (e.g. 0, 1, 2, 3, ...) * starting from `_startTokenId()`. * * Assumptions: * * - An owner cannot have more than 2**64 - 1 (max value of uint64) of supply. * - The maximum token ID cannot exceed 2**256 - 1 (max value of uint256). */ contract ERC721AUpgradeable is ERC721A__Initializable, IERC721AUpgradeable { using ERC721AStorage for ERC721AStorage.Layout; // ============================================================= // CONSTANTS // ============================================================= // Mask of an entry in packed address data. uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY = (1 << 64) - 1; // The bit position of `numberMinted` in packed address data. uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED = 64; // The bit position of `numberBurned` in packed address data. uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED = 128; // The bit position of `aux` in packed address data. uint256 private constant _BITPOS_AUX = 192; // Mask of all 256 bits in packed address data except the 64 bits for `aux`. uint256 private constant _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 192) - 1; // The bit position of `startTimestamp` in packed ownership. uint256 private constant _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP = 160; // The bit mask of the `burned` bit in packed ownership. uint256 private constant _BITMASK_BURNED = 1 << 224; // The bit position of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership. uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 225; // The bit mask of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership. uint256 private constant _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 1 << 225; // The bit position of `extraData` in packed ownership. uint256 private constant _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA = 232; // Mask of all 256 bits in a packed ownership except the 24 bits for `extraData`. uint256 private constant _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 232) - 1; // The mask of the lower 160 bits for addresses. uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS = (1 << 160) - 1; // The maximum `quantity` that can be minted with {_mintERC2309}. // This limit is to prevent overflows on the address data entries. // For a limit of 5000, a total of 3.689e15 calls to {_mintERC2309} // is required to cause an overflow, which is unrealistic. uint256 private constant _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT = 5000; // The `Transfer` event signature is given by: // `keccak256(bytes("Transfer(address,address,uint256)"))`. bytes32 private constant _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE = 0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef; // ============================================================= // CONSTRUCTOR // ============================================================= function __ERC721A_init(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) internal onlyInitializingERC721A { __ERC721A_init_unchained(name_, symbol_); } function __ERC721A_init_unchained(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) internal onlyInitializingERC721A { ERC721AStorage.layout()._name = name_; ERC721AStorage.layout()._symbol = symbol_; ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex = _startTokenId(); } // ============================================================= // TOKEN COUNTING OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the starting token ID. * To change the starting token ID, please override this function. */ function _startTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) { return 0; } /** * @dev Returns the next token ID to be minted. */ function _nextTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) { return ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex; } /** * @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence. * Burned tokens will reduce the count. * To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}. */ function totalSupply() public view virtual override returns (uint256) { // Counter underflow is impossible as _burnCounter cannot be incremented // more than `_currentIndex - _startTokenId()` times. unchecked { return ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex - ERC721AStorage.layout()._burnCounter - _startTokenId(); } } /** * @dev Returns the total amount of tokens minted in the contract. */ function _totalMinted() internal view virtual returns (uint256) { // Counter underflow is impossible as `_currentIndex` does not decrement, // and it is initialized to `_startTokenId()`. unchecked { return ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex - _startTokenId(); } } /** * @dev Returns the total number of tokens burned. */ function _totalBurned() internal view virtual returns (uint256) { return ERC721AStorage.layout()._burnCounter; } // ============================================================= // ADDRESS DATA OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account. */ function balanceOf(address owner) public view virtual override returns (uint256) { if (owner == address(0)) revert BalanceQueryForZeroAddress(); return ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY; } /** * Returns the number of tokens minted by `owner`. */ function _numberMinted(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) { return (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY; } /** * Returns the number of tokens burned by or on behalf of `owner`. */ function _numberBurned(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) { return (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY; } /** * Returns the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used). */ function _getAux(address owner) internal view returns (uint64) { return uint64(ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_AUX); } /** * Sets the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used). * If there are multiple variables, please pack them into a uint64. */ function _setAux(address owner, uint64 aux) internal virtual { uint256 packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner]; uint256 auxCasted; // Cast `aux` with assembly to avoid redundant masking. assembly { auxCasted := aux } packed = (packed & _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT) | (auxCasted << _BITPOS_AUX); ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] = packed; } // ============================================================= // IERC165 // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding * [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified) * to learn more about how these ids are created. * * This function call must use less than 30000 gas. */ function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) { // The interface IDs are constants representing the first 4 bytes // of the XOR of all function selectors in the interface. // See: [ERC165](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165) // (e.g. `bytes4(i.functionA.selector ^ i.functionB.selector ^ ...)`) return interfaceId == 0x01ffc9a7 || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC165. interfaceId == 0x80ac58cd || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721. interfaceId == 0x5b5e139f; // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721Metadata. } // ============================================================= // IERC721Metadata // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the token collection name. */ function name() public view virtual override returns (string memory) { return ERC721AStorage.layout()._name; } /** * @dev Returns the token collection symbol. */ function symbol() public view virtual override returns (string memory) { return ERC721AStorage.layout()._symbol; } /** * @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token. */ function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (string memory) { if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert URIQueryForNonexistentToken(); string memory baseURI = _baseURI(); return bytes(baseURI).length != 0 ? string(abi.encodePacked(baseURI, _toString(tokenId))) : ''; } /** * @dev Base URI for computing {tokenURI}. If set, the resulting URI for each * token will be the concatenation of the `baseURI` and the `tokenId`. Empty * by default, it can be overridden in child contracts. */ function _baseURI() internal view virtual returns (string memory) { return ''; } // ============================================================= // OWNERSHIPS OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. */ function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) { return address(uint160(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId))); } /** * @dev Gas spent here starts off proportional to the maximum mint batch size. * It gradually moves to O(1) as tokens get transferred around over time. */ function _ownershipOf(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) { return _unpackedOwnership(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId)); } /** * @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct at `index`. */ function _ownershipAt(uint256 index) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) { return _unpackedOwnership(ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index]); } /** * @dev Initializes the ownership slot minted at `index` for efficiency purposes. */ function _initializeOwnershipAt(uint256 index) internal virtual { if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index] == 0) { ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index] = _packedOwnershipOf(index); } } /** * Returns the packed ownership data of `tokenId`. */ function _packedOwnershipOf(uint256 tokenId) private view returns (uint256 packed) { if (_startTokenId() <= tokenId) { packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId]; // If not burned. if (packed & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0) { // If the data at the starting slot does not exist, start the scan. if (packed == 0) { if (tokenId >= ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex) revert OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken(); // Invariant: // There will always be an initialized ownership slot // (i.e. `ownership.addr != address(0) && ownership.burned == false`) // before an unintialized ownership slot // (i.e. `ownership.addr == address(0) && ownership.burned == false`) // Hence, `tokenId` will not underflow. // // We can directly compare the packed value. // If the address is zero, packed will be zero. for (;;) { unchecked { packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[--tokenId]; } if (packed == 0) continue; return packed; } } // Otherwise, the data exists and is not burned. We can skip the scan. // This is possible because we have already achieved the target condition. // This saves 2143 gas on transfers of initialized tokens. return packed; } } revert OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken(); } /** * @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct from `packed`. */ function _unpackedOwnership(uint256 packed) private pure returns (TokenOwnership memory ownership) { ownership.addr = address(uint160(packed)); ownership.startTimestamp = uint64(packed >> _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP); ownership.burned = packed & _BITMASK_BURNED != 0; ownership.extraData = uint24(packed >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA); } /** * @dev Packs ownership data into a single uint256. */ function _packOwnershipData(address owner, uint256 flags) private view returns (uint256 result) { assembly { // Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean. owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS) // `owner | (block.timestamp << _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP) | flags`. result := or(owner, or(shl(_BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP, timestamp()), flags)) } } /** * @dev Returns the `nextInitialized` flag set if `quantity` equals 1. */ function _nextInitializedFlag(uint256 quantity) private pure returns (uint256 result) { // For branchless setting of the `nextInitialized` flag. assembly { // `(quantity == 1) << _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED`. result := shl(_BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED, eq(quantity, 1)) } } // ============================================================= // APPROVAL OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account. See {ERC721A-_approve}. * * Requirements: * * - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator. */ function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) public payable virtual override { _approve(to, tokenId, true); } /** * @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. */ function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) { if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken(); return ERC721AStorage.layout()._tokenApprovals[tokenId].value; } /** * @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller. * Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom} * for any token owned by the caller. * * Requirements: * * - The `operator` cannot be the caller. * * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event. */ function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool approved) public virtual override { ERC721AStorage.layout()._operatorApprovals[_msgSenderERC721A()][operator] = approved; emit ApprovalForAll(_msgSenderERC721A(), operator, approved); } /** * @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`. * * See {setApprovalForAll}. */ function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) public view virtual override returns (bool) { return ERC721AStorage.layout()._operatorApprovals[owner][operator]; } /** * @dev Returns whether `tokenId` exists. * * Tokens can be managed by their owner or approved accounts via {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * * Tokens start existing when they are minted. See {_mint}. */ function _exists(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (bool) { return _startTokenId() <= tokenId && tokenId < ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex && // If within bounds, ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId] & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0; // and not burned. } /** * @dev Returns whether `msgSender` is equal to `approvedAddress` or `owner`. */ function _isSenderApprovedOrOwner( address approvedAddress, address owner, address msgSender ) private pure returns (bool result) { assembly { // Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean. owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS) // Mask `msgSender` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean. msgSender := and(msgSender, _BITMASK_ADDRESS) // `msgSender == owner || msgSender == approvedAddress`. result := or(eq(msgSender, owner), eq(msgSender, approvedAddress)) } } /** * @dev Returns the storage slot and value for the approved address of `tokenId`. */ function _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(uint256 tokenId) private view returns (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) { ERC721AStorage.TokenApprovalRef storage tokenApproval = ERC721AStorage.layout()._tokenApprovals[tokenId]; // The following is equivalent to `approvedAddress = _tokenApprovals[tokenId].value`. assembly { approvedAddressSlot := tokenApproval.slot approvedAddress := sload(approvedAddressSlot) } } // ============================================================= // TRANSFER OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`. * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token * by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) public payable virtual override { uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId); if (address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked)) != from) revert TransferFromIncorrectOwner(); (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId); // The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition. if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A())) if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) revert TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved(); if (to == address(0)) revert TransferToZeroAddress(); _beforeTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1); // Clear approvals from the previous owner. assembly { if approvedAddress { // This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`. sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0) } } // Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for // ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow. // Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256. unchecked { // We can directly increment and decrement the balances. --ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[from]; // Updates: `balance -= 1`. ++ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[to]; // Updates: `balance += 1`. // Updates: // - `address` to the next owner. // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of transfering. // - `burned` to `false`. // - `nextInitialized` to `true`. ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData( to, _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED | _nextExtraData(from, to, prevOwnershipPacked) ); // If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) . if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) { uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1; // If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero). if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) { // If the next slot is within bounds. if (nextTokenId != ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex) { // Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`. ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked; } } } } emit Transfer(from, to, tokenId); _afterTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1); } /** * @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`. */ function safeTransferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) public payable virtual override { safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, ''); } /** * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`. * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token * by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement * {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function safeTransferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes memory _data ) public payable virtual override { transferFrom(from, to, tokenId); if (to.code.length != 0) if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(from, to, tokenId, _data)) { revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer(); } } /** * @dev Hook that is called before a set of serially-ordered token IDs * are about to be transferred. This includes minting. * And also called before burning one token. * * `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred. * `quantity` - the amount to be transferred. * * Calling conditions: * * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be * transferred to `to`. * - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`. * - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`. * - `from` and `to` are never both zero. */ function _beforeTokenTransfers( address from, address to, uint256 startTokenId, uint256 quantity ) internal virtual {} /** * @dev Hook that is called after a set of serially-ordered token IDs * have been transferred. This includes minting. * And also called after one token has been burned. * * `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred. * `quantity` - the amount to be transferred. * * Calling conditions: * * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` has been * transferred to `to`. * - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` has been minted for `to`. * - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` has been burned by `from`. * - `from` and `to` are never both zero. */ function _afterTokenTransfers( address from, address to, uint256 startTokenId, uint256 quantity ) internal virtual {} /** * @dev Private function to invoke {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received} on a target contract. * * `from` - Previous owner of the given token ID. * `to` - Target address that will receive the token. * `tokenId` - Token ID to be transferred. * `_data` - Optional data to send along with the call. * * Returns whether the call correctly returned the expected magic value. */ function _checkContractOnERC721Received( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes memory _data ) private returns (bool) { try ERC721A__IERC721ReceiverUpgradeable(to).onERC721Received(_msgSenderERC721A(), from, tokenId, _data) returns (bytes4 retval) { return retval == ERC721A__IERC721ReceiverUpgradeable(to).onERC721Received.selector; } catch (bytes memory reason) { if (reason.length == 0) { revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer(); } else { assembly { revert(add(32, reason), mload(reason)) } } } } // ============================================================= // MINT OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`. * * Requirements: * * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `quantity` must be greater than 0. * * Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint. */ function _mint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual { uint256 startTokenId = ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex; if (quantity == 0) revert MintZeroQuantity(); _beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity); // Overflows are incredibly unrealistic. // `balance` and `numberMinted` have a maximum limit of 2**64. // `tokenId` has a maximum limit of 2**256. unchecked { // Updates: // - `balance += quantity`. // - `numberMinted += quantity`. // // We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`. ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1); // Updates: // - `address` to the owner. // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting. // - `burned` to `false`. // - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`. ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData( to, _nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0) ); uint256 toMasked; uint256 end = startTokenId + quantity; // Use assembly to loop and emit the `Transfer` event for gas savings. // The duplicated `log4` removes an extra check and reduces stack juggling. // The assembly, together with the surrounding Solidity code, have been // delicately arranged to nudge the compiler into producing optimized opcodes. assembly { // Mask `to` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean. toMasked := and(to, _BITMASK_ADDRESS) // Emit the `Transfer` event. log4( 0, // Start of data (0, since no data). 0, // End of data (0, since no data). _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, // Signature. 0, // `address(0)`. toMasked, // `to`. startTokenId // `tokenId`. ) // The `iszero(eq(,))` check ensures that large values of `quantity` // that overflows uint256 will make the loop run out of gas. // The compiler will optimize the `iszero` away for performance. for { let tokenId := add(startTokenId, 1) } iszero(eq(tokenId, end)) { tokenId := add(tokenId, 1) } { // Emit the `Transfer` event. Similar to above. log4(0, 0, _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, 0, toMasked, tokenId) } } if (toMasked == 0) revert MintToZeroAddress(); ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex = end; } _afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity); } /** * @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`. * * This function is intended for efficient minting only during contract creation. * * It emits only one {ConsecutiveTransfer} as defined in * [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309), * instead of a sequence of {Transfer} event(s). * * Calling this function outside of contract creation WILL make your contract * non-compliant with the ERC721 standard. * For full ERC721 compliance, substituting ERC721 {Transfer} event(s) with the ERC2309 * {ConsecutiveTransfer} event is only permissible during contract creation. * * Requirements: * * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `quantity` must be greater than 0. * * Emits a {ConsecutiveTransfer} event. */ function _mintERC2309(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual { uint256 startTokenId = ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex; if (to == address(0)) revert MintToZeroAddress(); if (quantity == 0) revert MintZeroQuantity(); if (quantity > _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT) revert MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit(); _beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity); // Overflows are unrealistic due to the above check for `quantity` to be below the limit. unchecked { // Updates: // - `balance += quantity`. // - `numberMinted += quantity`. // // We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`. ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1); // Updates: // - `address` to the owner. // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting. // - `burned` to `false`. // - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`. ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData( to, _nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0) ); emit ConsecutiveTransfer(startTokenId, startTokenId + quantity - 1, address(0), to); ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex = startTokenId + quantity; } _afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity); } /** * @dev Safely mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`. * * Requirements: * * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement * {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called for each safe transfer. * - `quantity` must be greater than 0. * * See {_mint}. * * Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint. */ function _safeMint( address to, uint256 quantity, bytes memory _data ) internal virtual { _mint(to, quantity); unchecked { if (to.code.length != 0) { uint256 end = ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex; uint256 index = end - quantity; do { if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(address(0), to, index++, _data)) { revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer(); } } while (index < end); // Reentrancy protection. if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex != end) revert(); } } } /** * @dev Equivalent to `_safeMint(to, quantity, '')`. */ function _safeMint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual { _safeMint(to, quantity, ''); } // ============================================================= // APPROVAL OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Equivalent to `_approve(to, tokenId, false)`. */ function _approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) internal virtual { _approve(to, tokenId, false); } /** * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account. * The approval is cleared when the token is transferred. * * Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the * zero address clears previous approvals. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. * * Emits an {Approval} event. */ function _approve( address to, uint256 tokenId, bool approvalCheck ) internal virtual { address owner = ownerOf(tokenId); if (approvalCheck) if (_msgSenderERC721A() != owner) if (!isApprovedForAll(owner, _msgSenderERC721A())) { revert ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved(); } ERC721AStorage.layout()._tokenApprovals[tokenId].value = to; emit Approval(owner, to, tokenId); } // ============================================================= // BURN OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Equivalent to `_burn(tokenId, false)`. */ function _burn(uint256 tokenId) internal virtual { _burn(tokenId, false); } /** * @dev Destroys `tokenId`. * The approval is cleared when the token is burned. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function _burn(uint256 tokenId, bool approvalCheck) internal virtual { uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId); address from = address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked)); (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId); if (approvalCheck) { // The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition. if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A())) if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) revert TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved(); } _beforeTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1); // Clear approvals from the previous owner. assembly { if approvedAddress { // This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`. sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0) } } // Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for // ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow. // Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256. unchecked { // Updates: // - `balance -= 1`. // - `numberBurned += 1`. // // We can directly decrement the balance, and increment the number burned. // This is equivalent to `packed -= 1; packed += 1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED;`. ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[from] += (1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) - 1; // Updates: // - `address` to the last owner. // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of burning. // - `burned` to `true`. // - `nextInitialized` to `true`. ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData( from, (_BITMASK_BURNED | _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED) | _nextExtraData(from, address(0), prevOwnershipPacked) ); // If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) . if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) { uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1; // If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero). if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) { // If the next slot is within bounds. if (nextTokenId != ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex) { // Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`. ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked; } } } } emit Transfer(from, address(0), tokenId); _afterTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1); // Overflow not possible, as _burnCounter cannot be exceed _currentIndex times. unchecked { ERC721AStorage.layout()._burnCounter++; } } // ============================================================= // EXTRA DATA OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Directly sets the extra data for the ownership data `index`. */ function _setExtraDataAt(uint256 index, uint24 extraData) internal virtual { uint256 packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index]; if (packed == 0) revert OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData(); uint256 extraDataCasted; // Cast `extraData` with assembly to avoid redundant masking. assembly { extraDataCasted := extraData } packed = (packed & _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT) | (extraDataCasted << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA); ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index] = packed; } /** * @dev Called during each token transfer to set the 24bit `extraData` field. * Intended to be overridden by the cosumer contract. * * `previousExtraData` - the value of `extraData` before transfer. * * Calling conditions: * * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be * transferred to `to`. * - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`. * - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`. * - `from` and `to` are never both zero. */ function _extraData( address from, address to, uint24 previousExtraData ) internal view virtual returns (uint24) {} /** * @dev Returns the next extra data for the packed ownership data. * The returned result is shifted into position. */ function _nextExtraData( address from, address to, uint256 prevOwnershipPacked ) private view returns (uint256) { uint24 extraData = uint24(prevOwnershipPacked >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA); return uint256(_extraData(from, to, extraData)) << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA; } // ============================================================= // OTHER OPERATIONS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the message sender (defaults to `msg.sender`). * * If you are writing GSN compatible contracts, you need to override this function. */ function _msgSenderERC721A() internal view virtual returns (address) { return msg.sender; } /** * @dev Converts a uint256 to its ASCII string decimal representation. */ function _toString(uint256 value) internal pure virtual returns (string memory str) { assembly { // The maximum value of a uint256 contains 78 digits (1 byte per digit), but // we allocate 0xa0 bytes to keep the free memory pointer 32-byte word aligned. // We will need 1 word for the trailing zeros padding, 1 word for the length, // and 3 words for a maximum of 78 digits. Total: 5 * 0x20 = 0xa0. let m := add(mload(0x40), 0xa0) // Update the free memory pointer to allocate. mstore(0x40, m) // Assign the `str` to the end. str := sub(m, 0x20) // Zeroize the slot after the string. mstore(str, 0) // Cache the end of the memory to calculate the length later. let end := str // We write the string from rightmost digit to leftmost digit. // The following is essentially a do-while loop that also handles the zero case. // prettier-ignore for { let temp := value } 1 {} { str := sub(str, 1) // Write the character to the pointer. // The ASCII index of the '0' character is 48. mstore8(str, add(48, mod(temp, 10))) // Keep dividing `temp` until zero. temp := div(temp, 10) // prettier-ignore if iszero(temp) { break } } let length := sub(end, str) // Move the pointer 32 bytes leftwards to make room for the length. str := sub(str, 0x20) // Store the length. mstore(str, length) } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3 // Creator: Chiru Labs pragma solidity ^0.8.4; /** * @dev Interface of ERC721A. */ interface IERC721AUpgradeable { /** * The caller must own the token or be an approved operator. */ error ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved(); /** * The token does not exist. */ error ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken(); /** * Cannot query the balance for the zero address. */ error BalanceQueryForZeroAddress(); /** * Cannot mint to the zero address. */ error MintToZeroAddress(); /** * The quantity of tokens minted must be more than zero. */ error MintZeroQuantity(); /** * The token does not exist. */ error OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken(); /** * The caller must own the token or be an approved operator. */ error TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved(); /** * The token must be owned by `from`. */ error TransferFromIncorrectOwner(); /** * Cannot safely transfer to a contract that does not implement the * ERC721Receiver interface. */ error TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer(); /** * Cannot transfer to the zero address. */ error TransferToZeroAddress(); /** * The token does not exist. */ error URIQueryForNonexistentToken(); /** * The `quantity` minted with ERC2309 exceeds the safety limit. */ error MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit(); /** * The `extraData` cannot be set on an unintialized ownership slot. */ error OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData(); // ============================================================= // STRUCTS // ============================================================= struct TokenOwnership { // The address of the owner. address addr; // Stores the start time of ownership with minimal overhead for tokenomics. uint64 startTimestamp; // Whether the token has been burned. bool burned; // Arbitrary data similar to `startTimestamp` that can be set via {_extraData}. uint24 extraData; } // ============================================================= // TOKEN COUNTERS // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence. * Burned tokens will reduce the count. * To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}. */ function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256); // ============================================================= // IERC165 // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding * [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified) * to learn more about how these ids are created. * * This function call must use less than 30000 gas. */ function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool); // ============================================================= // IERC721 // ============================================================= /** * @dev Emitted when `tokenId` token is transferred from `from` to `to`. */ event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 indexed tokenId); /** * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables `approved` to manage the `tokenId` token. */ event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed approved, uint256 indexed tokenId); /** * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables or disables * (`approved`) `operator` to manage all of its assets. */ event ApprovalForAll(address indexed owner, address indexed operator, bool approved); /** * @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account. */ function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256 balance); /** * @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. */ function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address owner); /** * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`, * checking first that contract recipients are aware of the ERC721 protocol * to prevent tokens from being forever locked. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`. * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be have been allowed to move * this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement * {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function safeTransferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes calldata data ) external payable; /** * @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`. */ function safeTransferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) external payable; /** * @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`. * * WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {safeTransferFrom} * whenever possible. * * Requirements: * * - `from` cannot be the zero address. * - `to` cannot be the zero address. * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`. * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token * by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 tokenId ) external payable; /** * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account. * The approval is cleared when the token is transferred. * * Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the * zero address clears previous approvals. * * Requirements: * * - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator. * - `tokenId` must exist. * * Emits an {Approval} event. */ function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) external payable; /** * @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller. * Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom} * for any token owned by the caller. * * Requirements: * * - The `operator` cannot be the caller. * * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event. */ function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool _approved) external; /** * @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenId` must exist. */ function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address operator); /** * @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`. * * See {setApprovalForAll}. */ function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) external view returns (bool); // ============================================================= // IERC721Metadata // ============================================================= /** * @dev Returns the token collection name. */ function name() external view returns (string memory); /** * @dev Returns the token collection symbol. */ function symbol() external view returns (string memory); /** * @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token. */ function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (string memory); // ============================================================= // IERC2309 // ============================================================= /** * @dev Emitted when tokens in `fromTokenId` to `toTokenId` * (inclusive) is transferred from `from` to `to`, as defined in the * [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309) standard. * * See {_mintERC2309} for more details. */ event ConsecutiveTransfer(uint256 indexed fromTokenId, uint256 toTokenId, address indexed from, address indexed to); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.4; /// @notice Gas optimized ECDSA wrapper. /// @author Solady (https://github.com/vectorized/solady/blob/main/src/utils/ECDSA.sol) /// @author Modified from Solmate (https://github.com/transmissions11/solmate/blob/main/src/utils/ECDSA.sol) /// @author Modified from OpenZeppelin (https://github.com/OpenZeppelin/openzeppelin-contracts/blob/master/contracts/utils/cryptography/ECDSA.sol) library ECDSA { function recover(bytes32 hash, bytes calldata signature) internal view returns (address result) { assembly { if eq(signature.length, 65) { // Copy the free memory pointer so that we can restore it later. let m := mload(0x40) // Directly copy `r` and `s` from the calldata. calldatacopy(0x40, signature.offset, 0x40) // If `s` in lower half order, such that the signature is not malleable. // prettier-ignore if iszero(gt(mload(0x60), 0x7fffffffffffffffffffffffffffffff5d576e7357a4501ddfe92f46681b20a0)) { mstore(0x00, hash) // Compute `v` and store it in the scratch space. mstore(0x20, byte(0, calldataload(add(signature.offset, 0x40)))) pop( staticcall( gas(), // Amount of gas left for the transaction. 0x01, // Address of `ecrecover`. 0x00, // Start of input. 0x80, // Size of input. 0x40, // Start of output. 0x20 // Size of output. ) ) // Restore the zero slot. mstore(0x60, 0) // `returndatasize()` will be `0x20` upon success, and `0x00` otherwise. result := mload(sub(0x60, returndatasize())) } // Restore the free memory pointer. mstore(0x40, m) } } } function recover( bytes32 hash, bytes32 r, bytes32 vs ) internal view returns (address result) { assembly { // Copy the free memory pointer so that we can restore it later. let m := mload(0x40) // prettier-ignore let s := and(vs, 0x7fffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffff) // If `s` in lower half order, such that the signature is not malleable. // prettier-ignore if iszero(gt(s, 0x7fffffffffffffffffffffffffffffff5d576e7357a4501ddfe92f46681b20a0)) { mstore(0x00, hash) mstore(0x20, add(shr(255, vs), 27)) mstore(0x40, r) mstore(0x60, s) pop( staticcall( gas(), // Amount of gas left for the transaction. 0x01, // Address of `ecrecover`. 0x00, // Start of input. 0x80, // Size of input. 0x40, // Start of output. 0x20 // Size of output. ) ) // Restore the zero slot. mstore(0x60, 0) // `returndatasize()` will be `0x20` upon success, and `0x00` otherwise. result := mload(sub(0x60, returndatasize())) } // Restore the free memory pointer. mstore(0x40, m) } } function toEthSignedMessageHash(bytes32 hash) internal pure returns (bytes32 result) { assembly { // Store into scratch space for keccak256. mstore(0x20, hash) mstore(0x00, "\\x00\\x00\\x00\\x00\\x19Ethereum Signed Message:\ 32") // 0x40 - 0x04 = 0x3c result := keccak256(0x04, 0x3c) } } function toEthSignedMessageHash(bytes memory s) internal pure returns (bytes32 result) { assembly { // We need at most 128 bytes for Ethereum signed message header. // The max length of the ASCII reprenstation of a uint256 is 78 bytes. // The length of "\\x19Ethereum Signed Message:\ " is 26 bytes (i.e. 0x1a). // The next multiple of 32 above 78 + 26 is 128 (i.e. 0x80). // Instead of allocating, we temporarily copy the 128 bytes before the // start of `s` data to some variables. let m3 := mload(sub(s, 0x60)) let m2 := mload(sub(s, 0x40)) let m1 := mload(sub(s, 0x20)) // The length of `s` is in bytes. let sLength := mload(s) let ptr := add(s, 0x20) // `end` marks the end of the memory which we will compute the keccak256 of. let end := add(ptr, sLength) // Convert the length of the bytes to ASCII decimal representation // and store it into the memory. // prettier-ignore for { let temp := sLength } 1 {} { ptr := sub(ptr, 1) mstore8(ptr, add(48, mod(temp, 10))) temp := div(temp, 10) // prettier-ignore if iszero(temp) { break } } // Copy the header over to the memory. mstore(sub(ptr, 0x20), "\\x00\\x00\\x00\\x00\\x00\\x00\\x19Ethereum Signed Message:\ ") // Compute the keccak256 of the memory. result := keccak256(sub(ptr, 0x1a), sub(end, sub(ptr, 0x1a))) // Restore the previous memory. mstore(s, sLength) mstore(sub(s, 0x20), m1) mstore(sub(s, 0x40), m2) mstore(sub(s, 0x60), m3) } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.4; /// @notice Library for converting numbers into strings and other string operations. /// @author Solady (https://github.com/vectorized/solady/blob/main/src/utils/LibString.sol) /// @author Modified from Solmate (https://github.com/transmissions11/solmate/blob/main/src/utils/LibString.sol) library LibString { /*´:°•.°+.*•´.*:˚.°*.˚•´.°:°•.°•.*•´.*:˚.°*.˚•´.°:°•.°+.*•´.*:*/ /* CUSTOM ERRORS */ /*.•°:°.´+˚.*°.˚:*.´•*.+°.•°:´*.´•*.•°.•°:°.´:•˚°.*°.˚:*.´+°.•*/ error HexLengthInsufficient(); /*´:°•.°+.*•´.*:˚.°*.˚•´.°:°•.°•.*•´.*:˚.°*.˚•´.°:°•.°+.*•´.*:*/ /* DECIMAL OPERATIONS */ /*.•°:°.´+˚.*°.˚:*.´•*.+°.•°:´*.´•*.•°.•°:°.´:•˚°.*°.˚:*.´+°.•*/ function toString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory str) { assembly { // The maximum value of a uint256 contains 78 digits (1 byte per digit), but // we allocate 0xa0 bytes to keep the free memory pointer 32-byte word aligned. // We will need 1 word for the trailing zeros padding, 1 word for the length, // and 3 words for a maximum of 78 digits. Total: 5 * 0x20 = 0xa0. let m := add(mload(0x40), 0xa0) // Update the free memory pointer to allocate. mstore(0x40, m) // Assign the `str` to the end. str := sub(m, 0x20) // Zeroize the slot after the string. mstore(str, 0) // Cache the end of the memory to calculate the length later. let end := str // We write the string from rightmost digit to leftmost digit. // The following is essentially a do-while loop that also handles the zero case. // prettier-ignore for { let temp := value } 1 {} { str := sub(str, 1) // Write the character to the pointer. // The ASCII index of the '0' character is 48. mstore8(str, add(48, mod(temp, 10))) // Keep dividing `temp` until zero. temp := div(temp, 10) // prettier-ignore if iszero(temp) { break } } let length := sub(end, str) // Move the pointer 32 bytes leftwards to make room for the length. str := sub(str, 0x20) // Store the length. mstore(str, length) } } /*´:°•.°+.*•´.*:˚.°*.˚•´.°:°•.°•.*•´.*:˚.°*.˚•´.°:°•.°+.*•´.*:*/ /* HEXADECIMAL OPERATIONS */ /*.•°:°.´+˚.*°.˚:*.´•*.+°.•°:´*.´•*.•°.•°:°.´:•˚°.*°.˚:*.´+°.•*/ function toHexString(uint256 value, uint256 length) internal pure returns (string memory str) { assembly { let start := mload(0x40) // We need 0x20 bytes for the trailing zeros padding, `length * 2` bytes // for the digits, 0x02 bytes for the prefix, and 0x20 bytes for the length. // We add 0x20 to the total and round down to a multiple of 0x20. // (0x20 + 0x20 + 0x02 + 0x20) = 0x62. let m := add(start, and(add(shl(1, length), 0x62), not(0x1f))) // Allocate the memory. mstore(0x40, m) // Assign the `str` to the end. str := sub(m, 0x20) // Zeroize the slot after the string. mstore(str, 0) // Cache the end to calculate the length later. let end := str // Store "0123456789abcdef" in scratch space. mstore(0x0f, 0x30313233343536373839616263646566) let temp := value // We write the string from rightmost digit to leftmost digit. // The following is essentially a do-while loop that also handles the zero case. // prettier-ignore for {} 1 {} { str := sub(str, 2) mstore8(add(str, 1), mload(and(temp, 15))) mstore8(str, mload(and(shr(4, temp), 15))) temp := shr(8, temp) length := sub(length, 1) // prettier-ignore if iszero(length) { break } } if temp { // Store the function selector of `HexLengthInsufficient()`. mstore(0x00, 0x2194895a) // Revert with (offset, size). revert(0x1c, 0x04) } // Compute the string's length. let strLength := add(sub(end, str), 2) // Move the pointer and write the "0x" prefix. str := sub(str, 0x20) mstore(str, 0x3078) // Move the pointer and write the length. str := sub(str, 2) mstore(str, strLength) } } function toHexString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory str) { assembly { let start := mload(0x40) // We need 0x20 bytes for the trailing zeros padding, 0x20 bytes for the length, // 0x02 bytes for the prefix, and 0x40 bytes for the digits. // The next multiple of 0x20 above (0x20 + 0x20 + 0x02 + 0x40) is 0xa0. let m := add(start, 0xa0) // Allocate the memory. mstore(0x40, m) // Assign the `str` to the end. str := sub(m, 0x20) // Zeroize the slot after the string. mstore(str, 0) // Cache the end to calculate the length later. let end := str // Store "0123456789abcdef" in scratch space. mstore(0x0f, 0x30313233343536373839616263646566) // We write the string from rightmost digit to leftmost digit. // The following is essentially a do-while loop that also handles the zero case. // prettier-ignore for { let temp := value } 1 {} { str := sub(str, 2) mstore8(add(str, 1), mload(and(temp, 15))) mstore8(str, mload(and(shr(4, temp), 15))) temp := shr(8, temp) // prettier-ignore if iszero(temp) { break } } // Compute the string's length. let strLength := add(sub(end, str), 2) // Move the pointer and write the "0x" prefix. str := sub(str, 0x20) mstore(str, 0x3078) // Move the pointer and write the length. str := sub(str, 2) mstore(str, strLength) } } function toHexString(address value) internal pure returns (string memory str) { assembly { let start := mload(0x40) // We need 0x20 bytes for the length, 0x02 bytes for the prefix, // and 0x28 bytes for the digits. // The next multiple of 0x20 above (0x20 + 0x02 + 0x28) is 0x60. str := add(start, 0x60) // Allocate the memory. mstore(0x40, str) // Store "0123456789abcdef" in scratch space. mstore(0x0f, 0x30313233343536373839616263646566) let length := 20 // We write the string from rightmost digit to leftmost digit. // The following is essentially a do-while loop that also handles the zero case. // prettier-ignore for { let temp := value } 1 {} { str := sub(str, 2) mstore8(add(str, 1), mload(and(temp, 15))) mstore8(str, mload(and(shr(4, temp), 15))) temp := shr(8, temp) length := sub(length, 1) // prettier-ignore if iszero(length) { break } } // Move the pointer and write the "0x" prefix. str := sub(str, 32) mstore(str, 0x3078) // Move the pointer and write the length. str := sub(str, 2) mstore(str, 42) } } /*´:°•.°+.*•´.*:˚.°*.˚•´.°:°•.°•.*•´.*:˚.°*.˚•´.°:°•.°+.*•´.*:*/ /* OTHER STRING OPERATIONS */ /*.•°:°.´+˚.*°.˚:*.´•*.+°.•°:´*.´•*.•°.•°:°.´:•˚°.*°.˚:*.´+°.•*/ function replace( string memory subject, string memory search, string memory replacement ) internal pure returns (string memory result) { assembly { let subjectLength := mload(subject) let searchLength := mload(search) let replacementLength := mload(replacement) subject := add(subject, 0x20) search := add(search, 0x20) replacement := add(replacement, 0x20) result := add(mload(0x40), 0x20) let subjectEnd := add(subject, subjectLength) if iszero(gt(searchLength, subjectLength)) { let subjectSearchEnd := add(sub(subjectEnd, searchLength), 1) let h := 0 if iszero(lt(searchLength, 32)) { h := keccak256(search, searchLength) } let m := shl(3, sub(32, and(searchLength, 31))) let s := mload(search) // prettier-ignore for {} 1 {} { let t := mload(subject) // Whether the first `searchLength % 32` bytes of // `subject` and `search` matches. if iszero(shr(m, xor(t, s))) { if h { if iszero(eq(keccak256(subject, searchLength), h)) { mstore(result, t) result := add(result, 1) subject := add(subject, 1) // prettier-ignore if iszero(lt(subject, subjectSearchEnd)) { break } continue } } // Copy the `replacement` one word at a time. // prettier-ignore for { let o := 0 } 1 {} { mstore(add(result, o), mload(add(replacement, o))) o := add(o, 0x20) // prettier-ignore if iszero(lt(o, replacementLength)) { break } } result := add(result, replacementLength) subject := add(subject, searchLength) if iszero(searchLength) { mstore(result, t) result := add(result, 1) subject := add(subject, 1) } // prettier-ignore if iszero(lt(subject, subjectSearchEnd)) { break } continue } mstore(result, t) result := add(result, 1) subject := add(subject, 1) // prettier-ignore if iszero(lt(subject, subjectSearchEnd)) { break } } } let resultRemainder := result result := add(mload(0x40), 0x20) let k := add(sub(resultRemainder, result), sub(subjectEnd, subject)) // Copy the rest of the string one word at a time. // prettier-ignore for {} lt(subject, subjectEnd) {} { mstore(resultRemainder, mload(subject)) resultRemainder := add(resultRemainder, 0x20) subject := add(subject, 0x20) } // Allocate memory for the length and the bytes, // rounded up to a multiple of 32. mstore(0x40, add(result, and(add(k, 0x40), not(0x1f)))) result := sub(result, 0x20) mstore(result, k) } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.4; /// @notice Gas optimized verification of proof of inclusion for a leaf in a Merkle tree. /// @author Solady (https://github.com/vectorized/solady/blob/main/src/utils/MerkleProofLib.sol) /// @author Modified from Solmate (https://github.com/transmissions11/solmate/blob/main/src/utils/MerkleProofLib.sol) /// @author Modified from OpenZeppelin (https://github.com/OpenZeppelin/openzeppelin-contracts/blob/master/contracts/utils/cryptography/MerkleProof.sol) library MerkleProofLib { function verify( bytes32[] calldata proof, bytes32 root, bytes32 leaf ) internal pure returns (bool isValid) { assembly { if proof.length { // Left shift by 5 is equivalent to multiplying by 0x20. let end := add(proof.offset, shl(5, proof.length)) // Initialize `offset` to the offset of `proof` in the calldata. let offset := proof.offset // Iterate over proof elements to compute root hash. // prettier-ignore for {} 1 {} { // Slot of `leaf` in scratch space. // If the condition is true: 0x20, otherwise: 0x00. let scratch := shl(5, gt(leaf, calldataload(offset))) // Store elements to hash contiguously in scratch space. // Scratch space is 64 bytes (0x00 - 0x3f) and both elements are 32 bytes. mstore(scratch, leaf) mstore(xor(scratch, 0x20), calldataload(offset)) // Reuse `leaf` to store the hash to reduce stack operations. leaf := keccak256(0x00, 0x40) offset := add(offset, 0x20) // prettier-ignore if iszero(lt(offset, end)) { break } } } isValid := eq(leaf, root) } } function verifyMultiProof( bytes32[] calldata proof, bytes32 root, bytes32[] calldata leafs, bool[] calldata flags ) internal pure returns (bool isValid) { // Rebuilds the root by consuming and producing values on a queue. // The queue starts with the `leafs` array, and goes into a `hashes` array. // After the process, the last element on the queue is verified // to be equal to the `root`. // // The `flags` array denotes whether the sibling // should be popped from the queue (`flag == true`), or // should be popped from the `proof` (`flag == false`). assembly { // If the number of flags is correct. // prettier-ignore for {} eq(add(leafs.length, proof.length), add(flags.length, 1)) {} { // Left shift by 5 is equivalent to multiplying by 0x20. // Compute the end calldata offset of `leafs`. let leafsEnd := add(leafs.offset, shl(5, leafs.length)) // These are the calldata offsets. let leafsOffset := leafs.offset let flagsOffset := flags.offset let proofOffset := proof.offset // We can use the free memory space for the queue. // We don't need to allocate, since the queue is temporary. let hashesFront := mload(0x40) let hashesBack := hashesFront // This is the end of the memory for the queue. let end := add(hashesBack, shl(5, flags.length)) // For the case where `proof.length + leafs.length == 1`. if iszero(flags.length) { // If `proof.length` is zero, `leafs.length` is 1. if iszero(proof.length) { isValid := eq(calldataload(leafsOffset), root) break } // If `leafs.length` is zero, `proof.length` is 1. if iszero(leafs.length) { isValid := eq(calldataload(proofOffset), root) break } } // prettier-ignore for {} 1 {} { let a := 0 // Pops a value from the queue into `a`. switch lt(leafsOffset, leafsEnd) case 0 { // Pop from `hashes` if there are no more leafs. a := mload(hashesFront) hashesFront := add(hashesFront, 0x20) } default { // Otherwise, pop from `leafs`. a := calldataload(leafsOffset) leafsOffset := add(leafsOffset, 0x20) } let b := 0 // If the flag is false, load the next proof, // else, pops from the queue. switch calldataload(flagsOffset) case 0 { // Loads the next proof. b := calldataload(proofOffset) proofOffset := add(proofOffset, 0x20) } default { // Pops a value from the queue into `a`. switch lt(leafsOffset, leafsEnd) case 0 { // Pop from `hashes` if there are no more leafs. b := mload(hashesFront) hashesFront := add(hashesFront, 0x20) } default { // Otherwise, pop from `leafs`. b := calldataload(leafsOffset) leafsOffset := add(leafsOffset, 0x20) } } // Advance to the next flag offset. flagsOffset := add(flagsOffset, 0x20) // Slot of `a` in scratch space. // If the condition is true: 0x20, otherwise: 0x00. let scratch := shl(5, gt(a, b)) // Hash the scratch space and push the result onto the queue. mstore(scratch, a) mstore(xor(scratch, 0x20), b) mstore(hashesBack, keccak256(0x00, 0x40)) hashesBack := add(hashesBack, 0x20) // prettier-ignore if iszero(lt(hashesBack, end)) { break } } // Checks if the last value in the queue is same as the root. isValid := eq(mload(sub(hashesBack, 0x20)), root) break } } } }